677
|
1 *options.txt* For Vim version 7.0aa. Last change: 2006 Feb 20
|
7
|
2
|
|
3
|
|
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
|
5
|
|
6
|
|
7 Options *options*
|
|
8
|
|
9 1. Setting options |set-option|
|
|
10 2. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
|
|
11 3. Options summary |option-summary|
|
|
12
|
|
13 For an overview of options see help.txt |option-list|.
|
|
14
|
|
15 Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
|
|
16 achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
|
|
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
|
|
18 number has a numeric value
|
|
19 string has a string value
|
|
20
|
|
21 ==============================================================================
|
523
|
22 1. Setting options *set-option* *E764*
|
7
|
23
|
|
24 *:se* *:set*
|
|
25 :se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value.
|
|
26
|
|
27 :se[t] all Show all but terminal options.
|
|
28
|
|
29 :se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
|
|
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
|
|
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
|
|
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
|
|
33
|
|
34 *E518* *E519*
|
|
35 :se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
|
|
36
|
|
37 :se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
|
|
38 Number option: show value.
|
|
39 String option: show value.
|
|
40
|
|
41 :se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
|
|
42
|
|
43 :se[t] {option}! or
|
|
44 :se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. {not in Vi}
|
|
45
|
|
46 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
|
|
47 :se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
|
|
48 current value of 'compatible'. {not in Vi}
|
|
49 :se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. {not in Vi}
|
|
50 :se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. {not in Vi}
|
|
51
|
|
52 :se[t] all& Set all options, except terminal options, to their
|
10
|
53 default value. The values of 'term', 'lines' and
|
7
|
54 'columns' are not changed. {not in Vi}
|
|
55
|
|
56 *:set-args* *E487* *E521*
|
|
57 :se[t] {option}={value} or
|
|
58 :se[t] {option}:{value}
|
|
59 Set string or number option to {value}.
|
|
60 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
|
|
61 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0')
|
|
62 (hex and octal are only available for machines which
|
|
63 have the strtol() function).
|
|
64 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
|
|
65 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
|
|
66 set). See |cmdline-completion|.
|
|
67 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
|
|
68 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
|
|
69 is not allowed.
|
|
70 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
|
|
71 backslashes in {value}.
|
|
72
|
|
73 :se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
|
|
74 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
|
|
75 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
|
|
76 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
|
|
77 value was empty.
|
|
78 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
|
557
|
79 are removed. When adding a flag that was already
|
|
80 present the option value doesn't change.
|
7
|
81 < Also see |:set-args| above.
|
|
82 {not in Vi}
|
|
83
|
|
84 :se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
|
|
85 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
|
|
86 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
|
|
87 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
|
|
88 value was empty.
|
|
89 Also see |:set-args| above.
|
|
90 {not in Vi}
|
|
91
|
|
92 :se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
|
|
93 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
|
|
94 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
|
|
95 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
|
|
96 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
|
|
97 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
|
|
98 becomes empty.
|
|
99 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
|
|
100 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
|
|
101 one by one to avoid problems.
|
|
102 Also see |:set-args| above.
|
|
103 {not in Vi}
|
|
104
|
|
105 The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
|
|
106 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
|
|
107 If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
|
|
108 and the following arguments will be ignored.
|
|
109
|
|
110 *:set-verbose*
|
|
111 When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
|
|
112 was last set. Example: >
|
|
113 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
|
|
114 shiftwidth=4
|
|
115 Last set from modeline
|
|
116 cindent
|
|
117 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim
|
|
118 This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":set
|
|
119 all" or ":set" without an argument.
|
|
120 When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message. There is only
|
|
121 one value for all local options with the same name. Thus the message applies
|
|
122 to the option name, not necessarily its value.
|
|
123 When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
|
|
124 autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
|
|
125 Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
|
|
126 'compatible'.
|
|
127 {not available when compiled without the +eval feature}
|
|
128
|
|
129 *:set-termcap* *E522*
|
667
|
130 For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will
|
7
|
131 override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
|
|
132 the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
|
|
133 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
|
|
134 This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
|
|
135 example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
|
|
136 :set <M-b>=^[b
|
|
137 (the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
|
|
138 The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
|
|
139
|
36
|
140 The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
141 security reasons.
|
|
142
|
7
|
143 The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
|
10
|
144 at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
|
7
|
145 "set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
|
|
146 |more-prompt|.
|
|
147
|
|
148 *option-backslash*
|
|
149 To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
|
|
150 backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
|
|
151 means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
|
|
152 down).
|
|
153 A few examples: >
|
|
154 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags"
|
|
155 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
|
|
156 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file"
|
|
157
|
10
|
158 The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
|
|
159 include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
|
7
|
160 'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
|
|
161 :set titlestring=hi\|there
|
|
162 This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
|
|
163 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
|
|
164
|
642
|
165 Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in
|
|
166 the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring'
|
|
167 option to 'hi "there"': >
|
|
168 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\"
|
|
169
|
10
|
170 For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More
|
7
|
171 precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment
|
|
172 variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not
|
|
173 removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma,
|
|
174 etc.) is used like explained above.
|
|
175 There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
|
|
176 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
|
|
177 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
|
|
178 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
|
|
179 For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
|
|
180 are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
|
10
|
181 halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
|
7
|
182 result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
|
|
183
|
|
184 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
|
|
185 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
|
|
186 Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
|
|
187 option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
|
|
188 :set guioptions+=a
|
|
189 Remove a flag from an option like this: >
|
|
190 :set guioptions-=a
|
|
191 This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
|
10
|
192 Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
|
7
|
193 the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
|
|
194 doesn't appear.
|
|
195
|
|
196 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
|
22
|
197 Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
|
7
|
198 environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
|
|
199 name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
|
|
200 are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
|
|
201 follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
|
|
202 appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
|
|
203 :set term=$TERM.new
|
|
204 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
|
|
205 When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
|
|
206 opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
|
|
207
|
|
208
|
|
209 Handling of local options *local-options*
|
|
210
|
|
211 Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
|
|
212 has its own copy of this option, thus can each have their own value. This
|
|
213 allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
|
|
214 'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
|
|
215
|
|
216 The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
|
|
217 situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
|
|
218 the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
|
|
219 expects is a bit complicated...
|
|
220
|
|
221 When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
|
|
222 right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
|
|
223
|
|
224 When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
|
|
225 the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
|
|
226 these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
|
|
227 global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
|
|
228 global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
|
|
229 thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
|
|
230
|
|
231 When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the last used window
|
|
232 options are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this window, the
|
|
233 values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the window where
|
|
234 the buffer was edited last are used.
|
|
235
|
|
236 It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
|
|
237 When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
|
|
238 using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
|
|
239 local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
|
|
240 has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
|
|
241 global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
|
|
242 :e one
|
|
243 :set list
|
|
244 :e two
|
|
245 Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
|
|
246 command you have also set the global value. >
|
|
247 :set nolist
|
|
248 :e one
|
|
249 :setlocal list
|
|
250 :e two
|
|
251 Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
|
|
252 value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
|
|
253 global value. Note that if you do this next: >
|
|
254 :e one
|
|
255 You will not get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited
|
10
|
256 "one". The options local to a window are not remembered for each buffer.
|
7
|
257
|
|
258 *:setl* *:setlocal*
|
|
259 :setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
|
|
260 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
|
|
261 local value. If the option does not have a local
|
|
262 value the global value is set.
|
|
263 With the "all" argument: display all local option's
|
|
264 local values.
|
|
265 Without argument: Display all local option's local
|
|
266 values which are different from the default.
|
|
267 When displaying a specific local option, show the
|
|
268 local value. For a global option the global value is
|
|
269 shown (but that might change in the future).
|
|
270 {not in Vi}
|
|
271
|
|
272 :setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value.
|
|
273 {not in Vi}
|
|
274
|
|
275 *:setg* *:setglobal*
|
|
276 :setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
|
|
277 option without changing the local value.
|
|
278 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
|
|
279 With the "all" argument: display all local option's
|
|
280 global values.
|
|
281 Without argument: display all local option's global
|
|
282 values which are different from the default.
|
|
283 {not in Vi}
|
|
284
|
|
285 For buffer-local and window-local options:
|
|
286 Command global value local value ~
|
|
287 :set option=value set set
|
|
288 :setlocal option=value - set
|
|
289 :setglobal option=value set -
|
|
290 :set option? - display
|
|
291 :setlocal option? - display
|
|
292 :setglobal option? display -
|
|
293
|
|
294
|
|
295 Global options with a local value *global-local*
|
|
296
|
40
|
297 Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
|
|
298 For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
|
|
299 You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
|
|
300 use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
|
|
301 value.
|
7
|
302
|
|
303 For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
|
|
304 'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
|
|
305 :set makeprg=gmake
|
|
306 then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
|
|
307 the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
|
|
308 However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
|
|
309 another 'makeprog' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
|
10
|
310 files. You use this command: >
|
7
|
311 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
|
|
312 You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
|
|
313 :setlocal makeprg=
|
|
314 This only works for a string option. For a boolean option you need to use the
|
|
315 "<" flag, like this: >
|
|
316 :setlocal autoread<
|
|
317 Note that for non-boolean options using "<" copies the global value to the
|
|
318 local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value (that matters
|
|
319 when changing the global value later).
|
|
320 Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using
|
|
321 ":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
|
|
322
|
|
323
|
|
324 Setting the filetype
|
|
325
|
|
326 :setf[iletype] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
|
|
327 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
|
|
328 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
|
|
329 This is short for: >
|
|
330 :if !did_filetype()
|
|
331 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
|
|
332 :endif
|
|
333 < This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
|
|
334 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
|
|
335 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
|
|
336 {not in Vi}
|
|
337
|
|
338 :bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
|
|
339 :opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
|
|
340 Options are grouped by function.
|
|
341 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
|
|
342 short help to open a help window with more help for
|
|
343 the option.
|
|
344 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
|
|
345 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
|
|
346 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
|
|
347 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
|
|
348 window, in which case the window below help window is
|
|
349 used (skipping the option-window).
|
|
350 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| or
|
|
351 |+autocmd| features}
|
|
352
|
|
353 *$HOME*
|
|
354 Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
|
|
355 option and after a space or comma.
|
|
356
|
|
357 On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
|
|
358 of user "user". Example: >
|
|
359 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
|
|
360
|
|
361 On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
|
|
362 contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
|
|
363 "gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
|
|
364
|
|
365 NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
|
|
366 command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
|
|
367
|
|
368
|
|
369 Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
|
|
370 the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
|
|
371
|
|
372 *:fix* *:fixdel*
|
|
373 :fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
|
|
374 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
|
|
375 CTRL-? CTRL-H
|
|
376 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
|
|
377
|
|
378 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) {not in Vi}
|
|
379
|
|
380 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
|
|
381 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
|
|
382 your .vimrc: >
|
|
383 :fixdel
|
|
384 < This works no matter what the actual code for
|
|
385 backspace is.
|
|
386
|
|
387 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
|
|
388 use this: >
|
|
389 :if &term == "termname"
|
|
390 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
|
|
391 : fixdel
|
|
392 :endif
|
|
393 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
|
10
|
394 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
|
7
|
395 with your terminal name.
|
|
396
|
|
397 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
|
|
398 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
|
|
399 :if &term == "termname"
|
|
400 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
|
|
401 :endif
|
|
402 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
|
|
403 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
|
|
404 with your terminal name.
|
|
405
|
|
406 *Linux-backspace*
|
|
407 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
|
|
408 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
|
|
409 putting this line in your rc.local: >
|
|
410 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
|
|
411 <
|
|
412 *NetBSD-backspace*
|
|
413 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
|
|
414 the right code, try this: >
|
|
415 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
|
|
416 < If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
|
|
417 keysym 22 = BackSpace
|
|
418 < You need to restart for this to take effect.
|
|
419
|
|
420 ==============================================================================
|
|
421 2. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
|
|
422
|
|
423 Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
|
|
424 to set options automatically for one or more files:
|
|
425
|
|
426 1. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
|
|
427 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
|
|
428 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
|
|
429 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
|
|
430 |:mksession|.
|
|
431 2. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
|
|
432 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
|
|
433 many other things. See |autocommand|.
|
|
434 3. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
|
|
435 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
|
|
436 modelines. This is explained here.
|
|
437
|
|
438 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
|
|
439 There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
|
|
440 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
|
|
441
|
|
442 [text] any text or empty
|
|
443 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
|
|
444 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
|
|
445 [white] optional white space
|
|
446 {options} a list of option settings, separated with white space or ':',
|
|
447 where each part between ':' is the argument for a ":set"
|
|
448 command
|
|
449
|
|
450 Example: >
|
|
451 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6
|
|
452
|
|
453 The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
|
|
454
|
|
455 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
|
|
456
|
|
457 [text] any text or empty
|
|
458 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
|
|
459 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
|
|
460 [white] optional white space
|
|
461 se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space)
|
|
462 {options} a list of options, separated with white space, which is the
|
|
463 argument for a ":set" command
|
|
464 : a colon
|
|
465 [text] any text or empty
|
|
466
|
|
467 Example: >
|
|
468 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */
|
|
469
|
|
470 The white space before {vi:|vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the chance
|
|
471 that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception: "vi:" and
|
|
472 "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with version
|
|
473 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this could be
|
|
474 short for "example:").
|
|
475
|
|
476 *modeline-local*
|
|
477 The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
|
11
|
478 buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
|
|
479 options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
|
|
480 the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
|
|
481 depends on which one was opened last.
|
7
|
482
|
23
|
483 When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
|
|
484 from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
|
|
485 option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
|
|
486 in another window. But window-local options will be set.
|
|
487
|
7
|
488 *modeline-version*
|
|
489 If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
|
|
490 number can be specified where "vim:" is used:
|
|
491 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
|
|
492 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
|
|
493 vim={vers}: version {vers}
|
|
494 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
|
|
495 {vers} is 600 for Vim 6.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
|
|
496 For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 6.0 and later: >
|
|
497 /* vim600: set foldmethod=marker: */
|
|
498 To use a modeline for Vim before version 5.7: >
|
|
499 /* vim<570: set sw=4: */
|
|
500 There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
|
|
501
|
|
502
|
|
503 The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
|
|
504 If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
|
|
505
|
|
506 Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
|
|
507 like: >
|
|
508 /* vi:ts=4: */
|
|
509 will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK: >
|
|
510 /* vi:set ts=4: */
|
|
511
|
|
512 If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
|
|
513
|
|
514 If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
|
10
|
515 backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example: >
|
7
|
516 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */
|
|
517 This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the
|
|
518 ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
|
|
519
|
|
520 No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
|
|
521 might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines).
|
|
522
|
|
523 Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
|
|
524 define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
|
|
525 example: >
|
|
526 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
|
|
527 And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
|
|
528 "VAR".
|
|
529
|
|
530 ==============================================================================
|
|
531 3. Options summary *option-summary*
|
|
532
|
|
533 In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
|
|
534 an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
|
|
535
|
|
536 In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
|
|
537 is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
|
|
538
|
|
539 For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
|
|
540 used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
|
|
541 'compatible' is set.
|
|
542
|
|
543 Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
|
10
|
544 are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
|
7
|
545 different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
|
|
546 one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
|
|
547 at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
|
|
548 file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
|
|
549 the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
|
|
550 program.
|
|
551
|
|
552 global one option for all buffers and windows
|
|
553 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
|
|
554 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
|
|
555
|
|
556 When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
|
|
557 are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
|
|
558 buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
|
|
559 'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
|
|
560 buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
|
10
|
561 first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
|
|
562 is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
|
7
|
563 present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
|
|
564 buffer is created.
|
|
565
|
519
|
566 Hidden options *hidden-options*
|
|
567
|
|
568 Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported
|
|
569 features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces
|
|
570 below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an
|
|
571 error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden
|
|
572 option though, it is not stored.
|
|
573
|
|
574 To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: >
|
|
575 if exists('&foo')
|
|
576 This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really
|
|
577 supported use something like this: >
|
|
578 if exists('+foo')
|
|
579 <
|
7
|
580 *E355*
|
|
581 A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
|
582
|
|
583 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
|
|
584 'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise)
|
|
585 global
|
|
586 {not in Vi}
|
|
587 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
|
|
588 feature}
|
|
589 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
|
|
590 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
|
|
591 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
|
|
592 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
|
|
593 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
|
|
594 See |rileft.txt|.
|
|
595
|
|
596 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
|
|
597 'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
|
|
598 global
|
|
599 {not in Vi}
|
|
600 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
|
|
601 feature}
|
|
602 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
|
|
603 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
|
|
604 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
|
|
605 'revins'.
|
|
606 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
607
|
|
608 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
|
|
609 'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
|
|
610 global
|
|
611 {not in Vi}
|
|
612 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
|
|
613 feature}
|
233
|
614 When on, the second language is Farsi. In editing mode CTRL-_ toggles
|
7
|
615 the keyboard map between Farsi and English, when 'allowrevins' set.
|
|
616
|
233
|
617 When off, the keyboard map toggles between Hebrew and English. This
|
7
|
618 is useful to start the Vim in native mode i.e. English (left-to-right
|
|
619 mode) and have default second language Farsi or Hebrew (right-to-left
|
10
|
620 mode). See |farsi.txt|.
|
7
|
621
|
|
622 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
|
|
623 'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
|
|
624 global
|
|
625 {not in Vi}
|
|
626 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
|
|
627 feature}
|
|
628 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
|
|
629 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
|
|
630 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
|
|
631 letters, Cyrillic letters).
|
|
632
|
|
633 There are currently two possible values:
|
233
|
634 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
|
7
|
635 expected by most users.
|
|
636 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
|
|
637
|
|
638 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
|
|
639 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
|
|
640 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
|
|
641 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
|
233
|
642 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
|
7
|
643 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
|
233
|
644 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
|
7
|
645 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
|
|
646 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
|
|
647 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
|
|
648 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
|
|
649 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP
|
|
650 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode
|
|
651 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
|
|
652
|
|
653 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
|
|
654 'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
|
|
655 global
|
|
656 {not in Vi}
|
|
657 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
|
|
658 on Mac OS X}
|
|
659 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X
|
|
660 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
|
|
661 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
|
|
662 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
|
|
663 to its default (empty string).
|
|
664
|
|
665 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
|
|
666 'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
|
|
667 global
|
|
668 {not in Vi}
|
|
669 {only available when compiled with the
|
|
670 |+netbeans_intg| or |+sun_workshop| feature}
|
438
|
671 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
|
|
672 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
|
|
673 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
|
|
674 or selected.
|
|
675 This option is provided for backward compatibility with the Vim
|
|
676 released with Sun ONE Studio 4 Enterprise Edition.
|
|
677 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work. The directory
|
|
678 browser sets if off.
|
7
|
679
|
|
680 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
|
|
681 'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
|
|
682 local to window
|
|
683 {not in Vi}
|
|
684 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
|
|
685 feature}
|
|
686 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
|
|
687 Setting this option will:
|
|
688 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
|
|
689 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
|
|
690 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
|
|
691 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
|
|
692 - Set the 'delcombine' option
|
|
693 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
|
|
694
|
|
695 Resetting this option will:
|
|
696 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
|
|
697 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
|
|
698 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
|
|
699 option.
|
|
700 Also see |arabic.txt|.
|
|
701
|
|
702 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
|
|
703 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
|
|
704 'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
|
|
705 global
|
|
706 {not in Vi}
|
|
707 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
|
|
708 feature}
|
|
709 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
|
|
710 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
|
|
711 take affect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
|
|
712 one which encompasses:
|
|
713 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
|
|
714 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
|
|
715 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
|
|
716 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
|
|
717 When disabled the character display reverts back to each character's
|
|
718 true stand-alone form.
|
|
719 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
|
|
720 further details see |arabic.txt|.
|
|
721
|
|
722 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
|
|
723 'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
|
|
724 local to buffer
|
|
725 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
|
|
726 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
|
|
727 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
|
10
|
728 <Esc> or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor to
|
|
729 another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included in
|
|
730 'cpoptions'.
|
|
731 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
|
|
732 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
|
|
733 line.
|
7
|
734 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
|
|
735 a different way.
|
|
736 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
|
|
737 {small difference from Vi: After the indent is deleted when typing
|
|
738 <Esc> or <CR>, the cursor position when moving up or down is after the
|
|
739 deleted indent; Vi puts the cursor somewhere in the deleted indent}.
|
|
740
|
|
741 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
|
|
742 'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
|
|
743 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
744 {not in Vi}
|
|
745 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
|
|
746 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
|
|
747 When the file has been deleted this is not done. |timestamp|
|
|
748 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
|
|
749 using the global value: >
|
|
750 :set autoread<
|
|
751 <
|
|
752 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
|
|
753 'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
|
|
754 global
|
|
755 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
|
|
756 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!,
|
|
757 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a CTRL-O, CTRL-I,
|
|
758 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file.
|
|
759 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
|
|
760 'autowriteall' for that.
|
|
761
|
|
762 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
|
|
763 'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
|
|
764 global
|
|
765 {not in Vi}
|
|
766 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
|
|
767 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
|
|
768 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
|
|
769 been set.
|
|
770
|
|
771 *'background'* *'bg'*
|
|
772 'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light")
|
|
773 global
|
|
774 {not in Vi}
|
|
775 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
|
|
776 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
|
|
777 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
|
|
778 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
|
|
779 This will not always be correct.
|
|
780 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
|
|
781 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
|
|
782 color, see |:hi-normal|.
|
|
783
|
|
784 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for
|
10
|
785 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not
|
7
|
786 change.
|
|
787 When a color scheme is loaded (the "colors_name" variable is set)
|
|
788 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
|
|
789 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
|
|
790 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
|
|
791 be undone. First delete the "colors_name" variable when needed.
|
|
792
|
|
793 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
|
|
794 :set background&
|
|
795 < Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
|
|
796 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
|
|
797
|
|
798 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
|
|
799 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
|
|
800 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
|
|
801 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
|
|
802 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
|
|
803 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
|
|
804 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
|
|
805 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
|
|
806 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
|
|
807 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
|
|
808 :if &term == "pcterm"
|
|
809 : set background=dark
|
|
810 :endif
|
|
811 < When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
|
|
812 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
|
|
813 the setting of the 'background' option.
|
|
814 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
|
|
815 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
|
|
816 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
|
|
817 done with ":syntax on".
|
|
818
|
|
819 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
|
|
820 'backspace' 'bs' string (default "")
|
|
821 global
|
|
822 {not in Vi}
|
|
823 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
|
|
824 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
|
|
825 a way to backspace over something:
|
|
826 value effect ~
|
|
827 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
|
|
828 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
|
|
829 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
|
|
830 stop once at the start of insert.
|
|
831
|
|
832 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used.
|
|
833
|
|
834 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
|
|
835 value effect ~
|
|
836 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
|
|
837 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
|
|
838 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
|
|
839
|
|
840 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
|
|
841 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
842
|
|
843 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
|
|
844 'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
|
|
845 global
|
|
846 {not in Vi}
|
|
847 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
|
|
848 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
|
|
849 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
|
|
850 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
|
|
851 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
|
10
|
852 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
|
7
|
853 |backup-table| for more explanations.
|
|
854 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
|
|
855 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
|
|
856 oldest version of a file.
|
|
857 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
858
|
|
859 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
|
|
860 'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
|
|
861 global
|
|
862 {not in Vi}
|
|
863 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
|
|
864 done. This is a comma separated list of words.
|
|
865
|
|
866 The main values are:
|
|
867 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
|
|
868 "no" rename the file and write a new one
|
|
869 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
|
|
870
|
|
871 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
|
|
872 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
|
|
873 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
|
|
874
|
|
875 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
|
|
876 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
|
|
877 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
|
|
878 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
|
|
879 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
|
|
880 not of the real file.
|
|
881
|
|
882 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
|
|
883 + It's fast.
|
|
884 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
|
|
885 file.
|
|
886 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
|
|
887
|
|
888 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file
|
|
889 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and
|
|
890 and the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected,
|
|
891 a copy will be made.
|
|
892
|
|
893 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
|
|
894 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
|
|
895 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
|
|
896 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
|
|
897 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
|
|
898 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
|
|
899 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
|
|
900 be propagated back to the original source.
|
|
901 *crontab*
|
|
902 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
|
|
903 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
|
|
904 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
|
10
|
905 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
|
7
|
906 example.
|
|
907
|
|
908 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
|
|
909 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
|
|
910 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file
|
10
|
911 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
|
7
|
912 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
|
|
913 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
|
|
914 others.
|
|
915
|
|
916 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has
|
|
917 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
|
|
918 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
|
|
919 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
|
|
920 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
|
|
921 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
|
|
922 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
|
|
923 again not rename the file.
|
|
924
|
|
925 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
|
|
926 'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
|
|
927 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
|
|
928 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
|
|
929 global
|
|
930 {not in Vi}
|
|
931 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
|
|
932 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
|
|
933 where this is possible.
|
|
934 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is
|
|
935 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
|
|
936 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
|
|
937 as the edited file.
|
33
|
938 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
|
7
|
939 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The
|
|
940 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
|
|
941 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
|
|
942 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
|
|
943 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
|
|
944 name, precede it with a backslash.
|
|
945 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
|
|
946 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
|
|
947 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
|
|
948 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
|
|
949 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
|
|
950 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
|
|
951 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
|
|
952 of the option is removed.
|
|
953 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
|
|
954 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
|
|
955 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
|
|
956 < You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
|
|
957 home directory for this to work properly.
|
|
958 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
|
|
959 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
|
|
960 uses another default.
|
|
961 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
962 security reasons.
|
|
963
|
|
964 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
|
|
965 'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
|
|
966 global
|
|
967 {not in Vi}
|
|
968 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
|
|
969 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
|
|
970 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
|
|
971 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
|
|
972 ".bak" that you want to keep.
|
36
|
973 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
|
7
|
974
|
26
|
975 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
|
|
976 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
|
|
977 include a timestamp. >
|
|
978 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~'
|
|
979 < Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
|
|
980
|
7
|
981 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
|
|
982 'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
|
|
983 global
|
|
984 {not in Vi}
|
|
985 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
|
|
986 feature}
|
|
987 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
|
|
988 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
|
|
989 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
|
|
990 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
|
|
991 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
|
|
992 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
|
233
|
993 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
|
557
|
994 Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a
|
|
995 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see
|
|
996 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|.
|
7
|
997
|
|
998 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
|
|
999 'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
|
|
1000 global
|
|
1001 {not in Vi}
|
|
1002 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
|
|
1003 feature}
|
|
1004 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
|
|
1005
|
|
1006 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
|
|
1007 'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
|
|
1008 global
|
|
1009 {not in Vi}
|
|
1010 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
|
189
|
1011 feature}
|
7
|
1012 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality.
|
|
1013
|
189
|
1014 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
|
|
1015 'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
|
|
1016 global
|
|
1017 {not in Vi}
|
|
1018 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
|
|
1019 feature}
|
|
1020 Expression to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used when
|
|
1021 'ballooneval' is on. These variables can be used:
|
|
1022
|
|
1023 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
|
|
1024 v:beval_winnr number of the window
|
|
1025 v:beval_lnum line number
|
|
1026 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
|
|
1027 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
|
|
1028
|
|
1029 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
|
|
1030 Example: >
|
|
1031 function! MyBalloonExpr()
|
435
|
1032 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum .
|
189
|
1033 \', column ' . v:beval_col .
|
|
1034 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) .
|
|
1035 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"'
|
|
1036 endfunction
|
|
1037 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
|
|
1038 set ballooneval
|
|
1039 <
|
|
1040 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
|
|
1041 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
|
|
1042 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
|
|
1043 or Sun Workshop).
|
|
1044
|
634
|
1045 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
|
1046 |sandbox-option|.
|
|
1047
|
|
1048 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
|
1049 evaluating 'balloonexpr' |textlock|.
|
|
1050
|
446
|
1051 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
|
435
|
1052 if has("balloon_multiline")
|
|
1053 <
|
7
|
1054 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
|
|
1055 'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
|
|
1056 local to buffer
|
|
1057 {not in Vi}
|
|
1058 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
|
|
1059 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
|
|
1060 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
|
|
1061 'textwidth' will be set to 0
|
|
1062 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
|
|
1063 'modeline' will be off
|
|
1064 'expandtab' will be off
|
|
1065 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
|
|
1066 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
|
|
1067 separates lines).
|
|
1068 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
|
|
1069 file is read without conversion.
|
|
1070 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
|
|
1071 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
|
|
1072 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
|
|
1073 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
|
|
1074 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
|
|
1075 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
|
|
1076 saved option values.
|
|
1077 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
|
|
1078 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
|
|
1079 files you edit.
|
|
1080 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
|
|
1081 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
|
|
1082 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
|
|
1083 the 'endofline' option.
|
|
1084
|
|
1085 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
|
|
1086 'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
|
|
1087 global
|
|
1088 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
|
446
|
1089 When on the BIOS is called to obtain a keyboard character. This works
|
7
|
1090 better to detect CTRL-C, but only works for the console. When using a
|
|
1091 terminal over a serial port reset this option.
|
|
1092 Also see |'conskey'|.
|
|
1093
|
|
1094 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
|
|
1095 'bomb' boolean (default off)
|
|
1096 local to buffer
|
|
1097 {not in Vi}
|
|
1098 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
|
|
1099 feature}
|
|
1100 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
|
|
1101 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
|
|
1102 - this option is on
|
|
1103 - the 'binary' option is off
|
|
1104 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
|
|
1105 endian variants.
|
|
1106 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
|
|
1107 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
|
|
1108 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
|
|
1109 appear halfway the resulting file.
|
|
1110 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
|
|
1111 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
|
|
1112 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
|
|
1113 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
|
|
1114 will be restored when writing the file.
|
|
1115
|
|
1116 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
|
|
1117 'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
|
|
1118 global
|
|
1119 {not in Vi}
|
|
1120 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
|
|
1121 feature}
|
|
1122 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
|
500
|
1123 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
|
|
1124 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
|
7
|
1125
|
|
1126 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
|
29
|
1127 'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
|
7
|
1128 global
|
|
1129 {not in Vi} {only for Motif and Win32 GUI}
|
|
1130 Which directory to use for the file browser:
|
|
1131 last Use same directory as with last file browser.
|
|
1132 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
|
|
1133 current Use the current directory.
|
|
1134 {path} Use the specified directory
|
|
1135
|
|
1136 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
|
|
1137 'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
|
|
1138 local to buffer
|
|
1139 {not in Vi}
|
|
1140 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
|
|
1141 feature}
|
|
1142 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
|
|
1143 displayed in a window:
|
|
1144 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
|
|
1145 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden'
|
|
1146 is not set
|
|
1147 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using
|
|
1148 |:hide|
|
|
1149 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when
|
|
1150 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
|
|
1151 |:bdelete|
|
|
1152 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when
|
|
1153 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
|
|
1154 |:bwipeout|
|
|
1155
|
82
|
1156 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
|
|
1157 are lost without a warning.
|
7
|
1158 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
|
|
1159 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
|
|
1160
|
|
1161 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
|
|
1162 'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
|
|
1163 local to buffer
|
|
1164 {not in Vi}
|
|
1165 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
|
|
1166 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
|
|
1167 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
|
|
1168 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
|
|
1169 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
|
|
1170
|
|
1171 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
|
|
1172 'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
|
|
1173 local to buffer
|
|
1174 {not in Vi}
|
|
1175 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
|
|
1176 feature}
|
|
1177 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
|
|
1178 <empty> normal buffer
|
|
1179 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
|
|
1180 written
|
|
1181 nowrite buffer which will not be written
|
17
|
1182 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
|
|
1183 autocommands. {not available when compiled without the
|
|
1184 |+autocmd| feature}
|
7
|
1185 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
|
648
|
1186 or list of locations |:lwindow|
|
7
|
1187 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
|
|
1188 manually)
|
|
1189
|
|
1190 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
|
|
1191 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
|
|
1192
|
|
1193 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
|
|
1194
|
648
|
1195 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location
|
|
1196 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and
|
|
1197 you are not supposed to change it.
|
7
|
1198
|
|
1199 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
|
|
1200 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
|
|
1201 work (":w filename" does work though).
|
|
1202 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
|
|
1203 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
|
|
1204 example when you quit Vim.
|
|
1205 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
|
|
1206 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
|
|
1207 file).
|
|
1208 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
|
|
1209 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
|
|
1210 command.
|
17
|
1211 *E676*
|
|
1212 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
|
|
1213 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
|
|
1214 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
|
|
1215 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
|
|
1216 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
|
7
|
1217
|
|
1218 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
|
|
1219 'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
|
|
1220 global
|
|
1221 {not in Vi}
|
|
1222 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
|
|
1223 these words, separated by a comma:
|
|
1224 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
|
|
1225 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
|
493
|
1226 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
|
|
1227 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
|
|
1228 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
|
|
1229 functions are used when available.
|
7
|
1230 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
|
|
1231 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
|
|
1232 This probably only matters for Turkish.
|
|
1233
|
|
1234 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
|
|
1235 'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
|
|
1236 global
|
|
1237 {not in Vi}
|
|
1238 {not available when compiled without the
|
|
1239 |+file_in_path| feature}
|
|
1240 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
|
|
1241 |:cd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being searched
|
|
1242 for has a relative path (not starting with "/", "./" or "../").
|
|
1243 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
|
|
1244 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
|
|
1245 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
|
|
1246 in the current directory first.
|
|
1247 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
|
|
1248 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
|
|
1249 override it: >
|
|
1250 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
|
|
1251 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
1252 security reasons.
|
|
1253 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
|
|
1254
|
|
1255 *'cedit'*
|
|
1256 'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
|
|
1257 global
|
|
1258 {not in Vi}
|
|
1259 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
|
|
1260 feature}
|
|
1261 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
|
|
1262 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
|
|
1263 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
|
|
1264 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
|
|
1265 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: >
|
|
1266 :set cedit=<C-Y>
|
|
1267 :set cedit=<Esc>
|
|
1268 < |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
|
|
1269 See |cmdwin|.
|
|
1270
|
|
1271 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
|
|
1272 'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
|
|
1273 global
|
|
1274 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
|
|
1275 feature and the |+eval| feature}
|
|
1276 {not in Vi}
|
|
1277 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
|
|
1278 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
|
|
1279 different encoding from what is desired.
|
|
1280 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
|
|
1281 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
|
|
1282 preferred, because it is much faster.
|
|
1283 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
|
|
1284 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
|
|
1285 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success,
|
|
1286 non-zero for failure.
|
|
1287 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
|
|
1288 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
|
|
1289 used.
|
|
1290 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
|
|
1291 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
|
|
1292 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
|
|
1293 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
|
|
1294 Example: >
|
|
1295 set charconvert=CharConvert()
|
|
1296 fun CharConvert()
|
|
1297 system("recode "
|
|
1298 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to
|
|
1299 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out)
|
|
1300 return v:shell_error
|
|
1301 endfun
|
|
1302 < The related Vim variables are:
|
|
1303 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
|
|
1304 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
|
|
1305 v:fname_in name of the input file
|
|
1306 v:fname_out name of the output file
|
|
1307 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
|
|
1308 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
|
|
1309 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
|
|
1310 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
|
|
1311 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
|
|
1312 of this.
|
|
1313 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
1314 security reasons.
|
|
1315
|
|
1316 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
|
|
1317 'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
|
|
1318 local to buffer
|
|
1319 {not in Vi}
|
|
1320 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
|
|
1321 feature}
|
|
1322 Enables automatic C program indenting See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
|
|
1323 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
|
|
1324 preferred indent style.
|
|
1325 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
|
|
1326 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
|
|
1327 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
|
|
1328 external program.
|
|
1329 See |C-indenting|.
|
|
1330 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
|
|
1331 option or 'indentexpr'.
|
|
1332 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
|
|
1333 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
1334
|
|
1335 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
|
|
1336 'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
|
|
1337 local to buffer
|
|
1338 {not in Vi}
|
|
1339 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
|
|
1340 feature}
|
|
1341 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
|
|
1342 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
|
|
1343 empty.
|
|
1344 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
|
|
1345 See |C-indenting|.
|
|
1346
|
|
1347 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
|
|
1348 'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
|
|
1349 local to buffer
|
|
1350 {not in Vi}
|
|
1351 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
|
|
1352 feature}
|
|
1353 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
|
|
1354 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
|
|
1355 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
|
|
1356
|
|
1357
|
|
1358 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
|
|
1359 'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
|
|
1360 local to buffer
|
|
1361 {not in Vi}
|
|
1362 {not available when compiled without both the
|
|
1363 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features}
|
|
1364 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
|
|
1365 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
|
|
1366 an appropriate place (inside {}).
|
|
1367 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
|
|
1368 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
|
|
1369 "if,If,IF".
|
|
1370
|
|
1371 *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
|
|
1372 'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
|
|
1373 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
|
|
1374 global
|
|
1375 {not in Vi}
|
|
1376 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
|
|
1377 feature is included}
|
|
1378 This option is a list of comma separated names.
|
|
1379 These names are recognized:
|
|
1380
|
|
1381 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
|
|
1382 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
|
|
1383 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
|
|
1384 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
|
|
1385 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
|
|
1386 or not. The clipboard register can always be
|
|
1387 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
|
|
1388 |gui-clipboard|.
|
|
1389
|
|
1390 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
|
|
1391 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
|
|
1392 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
|
|
1393 windowing system's global selection or put the
|
|
1394 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
|
|
1395 register "*. See |guioptions_a| and |quotestar| for
|
|
1396 details. When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in
|
|
1397 'guioptions' is used, when the GUI is not active, this
|
|
1398 "autoselect" flag is used.
|
|
1399 Also applies to the modeless selection.
|
|
1400
|
|
1401 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
|
|
1402 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
|
|
1403
|
|
1404 exclude:{pattern}
|
|
1405 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
|
|
1406 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
|
|
1407 connection will be made to the X server. This is
|
|
1408 useful in this situation:
|
|
1409 - Running Vim in a console.
|
|
1410 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
|
|
1411 display.
|
|
1412 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
|
|
1413 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
|
|
1414 To never connect to the X server use: >
|
|
1415 exclude:.*
|
|
1416 < This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
|
|
1417 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
|
|
1418 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
|
|
1419 cannot be accessed.
|
|
1420 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
|
|
1421 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
|
|
1422 The rest of the option value will be used for
|
|
1423 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
|
|
1424
|
|
1425 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
|
|
1426 'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
|
|
1427 global
|
|
1428 {not in Vi}
|
|
1429 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding
|
|
1430 |hit-enter| prompts.
|
|
1431
|
|
1432 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
|
|
1433 'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
|
|
1434 global
|
|
1435 {not in Vi}
|
|
1436 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
|
|
1437 feature}
|
|
1438 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
|
|
1439
|
|
1440 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
|
|
1441 'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
|
|
1442 global
|
|
1443 {not in Vi}
|
|
1444 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
|
161
|
1445 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
|
|
1446 |posix-screen-size|.
|
7
|
1447 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
|
|
1448 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
|
|
1449 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
|
|
1450 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
|
|
1451 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up.
|
571
|
1452 Mimimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000.
|
7
|
1453
|
|
1454 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
|
|
1455 'comments' 'com' string (default
|
|
1456 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
|
|
1457 local to buffer
|
|
1458 {not in Vi}
|
|
1459 {not available when compiled without the |+comments|
|
|
1460 feature}
|
|
1461 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
|
|
1462 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
|
|
1463 insert a space.
|
|
1464
|
|
1465 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
|
|
1466 'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/")
|
|
1467 local to buffer
|
|
1468 {not in Vi}
|
|
1469 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
1470 feature}
|
|
1471 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
|
|
1472 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see
|
|
1473 |fold-marker|.
|
|
1474
|
|
1475 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
|
378
|
1476 'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a .vimrc or .gvimrc file
|
|
1477 is found)
|
7
|
1478 global
|
|
1479 {not in Vi}
|
|
1480 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
|
|
1481 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
|
|
1482 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
|
|
1483 other options are also changed as a side effect. CAREFUL: Setting or
|
|
1484 resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected effects: Mappings
|
10
|
1485 are interpreted in another way, undo behaves differently, etc. If you
|
7
|
1486 set this option in your vimrc file, you should probably put it at the
|
|
1487 very start.
|
|
1488 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
|
|
1489 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
|
|
1490 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
|
|
1491 option.
|
378
|
1492 When a ".vimrc" or ".gvimrc" file is found while Vim is starting up,
|
|
1493 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
|
|
1494 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
|
|
1495 that when a ".vimrc" or ".gvimrc" file exists, Vim will use the Vim
|
|
1496 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
|
|
1497 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file). Also see
|
|
1498 |compatible-default| and |posix-compliance|.
|
7
|
1499 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
|
|
1500 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
|
|
1501 Switching this option off makes the Vim defaults be used for options
|
|
1502 that have a different Vi and Vim default value. See the options
|
|
1503 marked with a '+' below. Other options are not modified.
|
|
1504 At the moment this option is set, several other options will be set
|
|
1505 or reset to make Vim as Vi-compatible as possible. See the table
|
10
|
1506 below. This can be used if you want to revert to Vi compatible
|
7
|
1507 editing.
|
|
1508 See also 'cpoptions'.
|
|
1509
|
|
1510 option + set value effect ~
|
|
1511
|
|
1512 'allowrevins' off no CTRL-_ command
|
|
1513 'backupcopy' Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
|
|
1514 others: "auto" copy or rename backup file
|
|
1515 'backspace' "" normal backspace
|
|
1516 'backup' off no backup file
|
|
1517 'cindent' off no C code indentation
|
|
1518 'cedit' + "" no key to open the |cmdwin|
|
|
1519 'cpoptions' + (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
|
|
1520 'cscopetag' off don't use cscope for ":tag"
|
|
1521 'cscopetagorder' 0 see |cscopetagorder|
|
|
1522 'cscopeverbose' off see |cscopeverbose|
|
|
1523 'digraph' off no digraphs
|
|
1524 'esckeys' + off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
|
|
1525 'expandtab' off tabs not expanded to spaces
|
|
1526 'fileformats' + "" no automatic file format detection,
|
|
1527 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2
|
|
1528 'formatoptions' + "vt" Vi compatible formatting
|
|
1529 'gdefault' off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
|
|
1530 'history' + 0 no commandline history
|
|
1531 'hkmap' off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
|
|
1532 'hkmapp' off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
|
|
1533 'hlsearch' off no highlighting of search matches
|
|
1534 'incsearch' off no incremental searching
|
|
1535 'indentexpr' "" no indenting by expression
|
|
1536 'insertmode' off do not start in Insert mode
|
|
1537 'iskeyword' + "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
|
|
1538 characters and '_'
|
|
1539 'joinspaces' on insert 2 spaces after period
|
|
1540 'modeline' + off no modelines
|
|
1541 'more' + off no pauses in listings
|
|
1542 'revins' off no reverse insert
|
|
1543 'ruler' off no ruler
|
|
1544 'scrolljump' 1 no jump scroll
|
|
1545 'scrolloff' 0 no scroll offset
|
|
1546 'shiftround' off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
|
|
1547 'shortmess' + "" no shortening of messages
|
|
1548 'showcmd' + off command characters not shown
|
|
1549 'showmode' + off current mode not shown
|
|
1550 'smartcase' off no automatic ignore case switch
|
|
1551 'smartindent' off no smart indentation
|
|
1552 'smarttab' off no smart tab size
|
|
1553 'softtabstop' 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
|
|
1554 'startofline' on goto startofline with some commands
|
|
1555 'tagrelative' + off tag file names are not relative
|
|
1556 'textauto' + off no automatic textmode detection
|
|
1557 'textwidth' 0 no automatic line wrap
|
|
1558 'tildeop' off tilde is not an operator
|
|
1559 'ttimeout' off no terminal timeout
|
|
1560 'whichwrap' + "" left-right movements don't wrap
|
|
1561 'wildchar' + CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
|
|
1562 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
|
|
1563 'writebackup' on or off depends on +writebackup feature
|
|
1564
|
|
1565 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
|
|
1566 'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
|
|
1567 local to buffer
|
|
1568 {not in Vi}
|
|
1569 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
|
|
1570 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
|
|
1571 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
|
|
1572 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags:
|
|
1573 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored)
|
|
1574 w scan buffers from other windows
|
|
1575 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
|
|
1576 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
|
|
1577 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
|
|
1578 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
|
|
1579 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
|
|
1580 patterns are valid too. For example: >
|
|
1581 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
|
|
1582 < s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
|
|
1583 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
|
|
1584 are valid too.
|
|
1585 i scan current and included files
|
|
1586 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
|
|
1587 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
|
|
1588 ] tag completion
|
|
1589 t same as "]"
|
|
1590
|
|
1591 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
|
|
1592 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
|
|
1593 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
|
|
1594 whole-line completion.
|
|
1595
|
|
1596 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
|
|
1597 1. the current buffer
|
|
1598 2. buffers in other windows
|
|
1599 3. other loaded buffers
|
|
1600 4. unloaded buffers
|
|
1601 5. tags
|
|
1602 6. included files
|
|
1603
|
|
1604 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
|
233
|
1605 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
|
|
1606 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
|
7
|
1607
|
12
|
1608 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
|
|
1609 'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
|
|
1610 local to buffer
|
|
1611 {not in Vi}
|
452
|
1612 {not available when compiled without the +eval
|
|
1613 or +insert_expand feature}
|
623
|
1614 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion
|
|
1615 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
|
648
|
1616 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
|
|
1617 invoked and what it should return.
|
|
1618
|
14
|
1619
|
540
|
1620 *'completeopt'* *'cot'*
|
|
1621 'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu")
|
|
1622 global
|
|
1623 {not in Vi}
|
665
|
1624 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion
|
|
1625 |ins-completion|. The supported values are:
|
540
|
1626
|
|
1627 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The
|
|
1628 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and
|
|
1629 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu|
|
|
1630
|
665
|
1631 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. Use
|
|
1632 CTRL-L to add more characters.
|
|
1633
|
540
|
1634
|
7
|
1635 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
|
|
1636 'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
|
|
1637 global
|
|
1638 {not in Vi}
|
|
1639 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
|
|
1640 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
|
|
1641 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
|
|
1642 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
|
|
1643 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
|
|
1644 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
|
|
1645 command.
|
|
1646 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
|
|
1647
|
|
1648 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
|
|
1649 'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
|
|
1650 global
|
|
1651 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
|
|
1652 When on direct console I/O is used to obtain a keyboard character.
|
10
|
1653 This should work in most cases. Also see |'bioskey'|. Together,
|
7
|
1654 three methods of console input are available:
|
|
1655 'conskey' 'bioskey' action ~
|
|
1656 on on or off direct console input
|
|
1657 off on BIOS
|
|
1658 off off STDIN
|
|
1659
|
|
1660 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
|
|
1661 'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
|
|
1662 local to buffer
|
|
1663 {not in Vi}
|
|
1664 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
|
|
1665 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
|
|
1666 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
|
|
1667 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
|
|
1668 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
|
|
1669 existing line. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
|
|
1670 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
|
|
1671 NOTE: 'copyindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
1672 Also see 'preserveindent'.
|
|
1673
|
|
1674 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'*
|
|
1675 'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs",
|
|
1676 Vi default: all flags)
|
|
1677 global
|
|
1678 {not in Vi}
|
|
1679 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
|
10
|
1680 this indicates vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
|
7
|
1681 not being vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
|
|
1682 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
|
|
1683 Commas can be added for readability.
|
|
1684 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
|
|
1685 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
|
|
1686 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
1687 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
164
|
1688 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
|
|
1689 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
|
|
1690 variable exists |posix|. This means tries to behave like the POSIX
|
|
1691 specification.
|
7
|
1692
|
|
1693 contains behavior ~
|
|
1694 *cpo-a*
|
|
1695 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
|
|
1696 argument will set the alternate file name for the
|
|
1697 current window.
|
|
1698 *cpo-A*
|
|
1699 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
|
|
1700 argument will set the alternate file name for the
|
|
1701 current window.
|
|
1702 *cpo-b*
|
|
1703 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
|
|
1704 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
|
|
1705 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
|
|
1706 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
|
|
1707 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
|
|
1708 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
|
|
1709 See also |map_bar|.
|
|
1710 *cpo-B*
|
|
1711 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
|
|
1712 abbreviations and the "to" part of the menu commands.
|
|
1713 Remove this flag to be able to use a backslash like a
|
|
1714 CTRL-V. For example, the command ":map X \<Esc>"
|
|
1715 results in X being mapped to:
|
|
1716 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
|
|
1717 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
|
|
1718 ('<' excluded in both cases)
|
|
1719 *cpo-c*
|
|
1720 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
|
|
1721 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
|
|
1722 next line. When not present searching continues
|
|
1723 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
|
|
1724 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
|
|
1725 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
|
|
1726 *cpo-C*
|
|
1727 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
|
|
1728 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
|
|
1729 *cpo-d*
|
|
1730 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
|
|
1731 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
|
|
1732 tags file in the current directory.
|
|
1733 *cpo-D*
|
|
1734 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
|
|
1735 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
|
|
1736 |t|.
|
|
1737 *cpo-e*
|
|
1738 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
|
|
1739 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
|
|
1740 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
|
|
1741 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
|
|
1742 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
|
|
1743 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
|
|
1744 *cpo-E*
|
|
1745 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
|
|
1746 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
|
|
1747 at least one character is to be operate on. Example:
|
|
1748 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
|
|
1749 *cpo-f*
|
|
1750 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
|
|
1751 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
|
|
1752 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
|
|
1753 *cpo-F*
|
|
1754 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
|
|
1755 argument will set the file name for the current
|
|
1756 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
|
590
|
1757 yet. Also see |cpo-P|.
|
7
|
1758 *cpo-g*
|
|
1759 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
|
164
|
1760 *cpo-H*
|
|
1761 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
|
|
1762 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
|
|
1763 the last blank.
|
7
|
1764 *cpo-i*
|
|
1765 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
|
|
1766 leave it modified.
|
10
|
1767 *cpo-I*
|
|
1768 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
|
|
1769 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
|
7
|
1770 *cpo-j*
|
|
1771 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
|
|
1772 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
|
|
1773 *cpo-J*
|
|
1774 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
|
233
|
1775 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
|
7
|
1776 white space.
|
|
1777 *cpo-k*
|
|
1778 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
|
|
1779 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
|
|
1780 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
|
|
1781 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
|
|
1782 being mapped to:
|
|
1783 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
|
|
1784 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
|
|
1785 Also see the '<' flag below.
|
|
1786 *cpo-K*
|
|
1787 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
|
|
1788 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
|
|
1789 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
|
|
1790 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
|
|
1791 *cpo-l*
|
|
1792 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
|
168
|
1793 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
|
|
1794 See |/[]|
|
7
|
1795 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
|
|
1796 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
|
168
|
1797 Also see |cpo-\|.
|
7
|
1798 *cpo-L*
|
|
1799 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
|
|
1800 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
|
|
1801 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
|
|
1802 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
|
|
1803 *cpo-m*
|
|
1804 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
|
|
1805 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
|
|
1806 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
|
|
1807 *cpo-M*
|
|
1808 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
|
|
1809 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
|
|
1810 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
|
|
1811 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
|
|
1812 *cpo-n*
|
|
1813 n When included, the column used for 'number' will also
|
|
1814 be used for text of wrapped lines.
|
|
1815 *cpo-o*
|
|
1816 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
|
|
1817 next search.
|
|
1818 *cpo-O*
|
|
1819 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
|
|
1820 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
|
|
1821 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
|
|
1822 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
|
|
1823 *cpo-p*
|
|
1824 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
|
|
1825 slightly better algorithm is used.
|
590
|
1826 *cpo-P*
|
|
1827 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a
|
|
1828 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if
|
|
1829 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and
|
|
1830 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|.
|
164
|
1831 *cpo-q*
|
|
1832 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
|
|
1833 position where it would be when joining two lines.
|
7
|
1834 *cpo-r*
|
|
1835 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
|
|
1836 command, instead of the actually used search string.
|
|
1837 *cpo-R*
|
|
1838 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
|
|
1839 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
|
|
1840 *cpo-s*
|
|
1841 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
|
|
1842 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
|
10
|
1843 And it is the default. If not present the options are
|
7
|
1844 set when the buffer is created.
|
|
1845 *cpo-S*
|
|
1846 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
|
|
1847 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
|
|
1848 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
|
|
1849 The options are set to the values in the current
|
|
1850 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
|
|
1851 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
|
|
1852 buffer options global to all buffers.
|
|
1853
|
|
1854 's' 'S' copy buffer options
|
|
1855 no no when buffer created
|
|
1856 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
|
|
1857 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
|
|
1858 *cpo-t*
|
|
1859 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
|
|
1860 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
|
|
1861 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
|
|
1862 last used search pattern.
|
|
1863 *cpo-u*
|
10
|
1864 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
|
7
|
1865 *cpo-v*
|
|
1866 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
|
|
1867 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
|
|
1868 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
|
|
1869 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
|
|
1870 characters.
|
|
1871 *cpo-w*
|
|
1872 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
|
|
1873 character and not all blanks until the start of the
|
|
1874 next word.
|
|
1875 *cpo-W*
|
|
1876 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
|
|
1877 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
|
|
1878 *cpo-x*
|
|
1879 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
|
|
1880 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
|
|
1881 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
|
164
|
1882 *cpo-X*
|
|
1883 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
|
|
1884 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
|
|
1885 and a count.
|
7
|
1886 *cpo-y*
|
|
1887 y A yank command can be redone with ".".
|
164
|
1888 *cpo-Z*
|
|
1889 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
|
|
1890 don't reset 'readonly'.
|
7
|
1891 *cpo-!*
|
|
1892 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
|
|
1893 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
|
|
1894 used -filter- command is used.
|
|
1895 *cpo-$*
|
|
1896 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
|
|
1897 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
|
|
1898 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
|
|
1899 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
|
|
1900 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
|
|
1901 point.
|
|
1902 *cpo-%*
|
|
1903 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
|
|
1904 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
|
|
1905 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
|
|
1906 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
|
|
1907 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
|
|
1908 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
|
|
1909 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
|
|
1910 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
|
|
1911 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
|
|
1912 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
|
|
1913 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
|
|
1914 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
|
10
|
1915 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
|
36
|
1916 This flag is also used for other features, such as
|
|
1917 C-indenting.
|
161
|
1918 *cpo--*
|
|
1919 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
|
632
|
1920 it would go above the first line or below the last
|
|
1921 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or
|
|
1922 last line, unless it already was in that line.
|
161
|
1923 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
|
632
|
1924 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234".
|
39
|
1925 *cpo-+*
|
|
1926 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
|
|
1927 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
|
|
1928 itself may still be different from its file.
|
164
|
1929 *cpo-star*
|
7
|
1930 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
|
|
1931 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
|
|
1932 *cpo-<*
|
|
1933 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
|
|
1934 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
|
10
|
1935 menu commands. For example, the command
|
7
|
1936 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
|
|
1937 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
|
|
1938 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
|
|
1939 Also see the 'k' flag above.
|
164
|
1940 *cpo->*
|
|
1941 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
|
|
1942 the appended text.
|
|
1943
|
|
1944 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
|
|
1945 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
|
|
1946
|
|
1947 contains behavior ~
|
|
1948 *cpo-#*
|
|
1949 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
|
168
|
1950 *cpo-&*
|
|
1951 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
|
|
1952 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
|
|
1953 This flag is tested when exiting.
|
|
1954 *cpo-\*
|
|
1955 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
|
|
1956 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
|
488
|
1957 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
|
|
1958 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
|
|
1959 Also see |cpo-l|.
|
168
|
1960 *cpo-/*
|
|
1961 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
|
|
1962 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
|
164
|
1963 *cpo-{*
|
|
1964 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
|
|
1965 at the start of a line.
|
168
|
1966 *cpo-.*
|
|
1967 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
|
|
1968 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
|
|
1969 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
|
|
1970 opened file.
|
164
|
1971 *cpo-bar*
|
|
1972 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
|
|
1973 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
|
|
1974 with system specific functions.
|
|
1975
|
7
|
1976
|
|
1977 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
|
|
1978 'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
|
|
1979 global
|
|
1980 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
|
|
1981 feature}
|
|
1982 {not in Vi}
|
|
1983 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
|
|
1984 See |cscopepathcomp|.
|
|
1985
|
|
1986 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
|
|
1987 'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
|
|
1988 global
|
|
1989 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
|
|
1990 feature}
|
|
1991 {not in Vi}
|
|
1992 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
|
|
1993 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
1994 security reasons.
|
|
1995
|
|
1996 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
|
|
1997 'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
|
|
1998 global
|
|
1999 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
|
|
2000 or |+quickfix| features}
|
|
2001 {not in Vi}
|
|
2002 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
|
|
2003 See |cscopequickfix|.
|
|
2004
|
|
2005 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
|
|
2006 'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
|
|
2007 global
|
|
2008 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
|
|
2009 feature}
|
|
2010 {not in Vi}
|
|
2011 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
|
|
2012 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
2013
|
|
2014 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
|
|
2015 'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
|
|
2016 global
|
|
2017 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
|
|
2018 feature}
|
|
2019 {not in Vi}
|
|
2020 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
|
|
2021 |cscopetagorder|.
|
|
2022 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
2023
|
|
2024 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
|
|
2025 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
|
|
2026 'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
|
|
2027 global
|
|
2028 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
|
|
2029 feature}
|
|
2030 {not in Vi}
|
|
2031 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
|
|
2032 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
2033
|
|
2034 *'debug'*
|
|
2035 'debug' string (default "")
|
|
2036 global
|
|
2037 {not in Vi}
|
|
2038 When set to "msg", error messages that would otherwise be omitted will
|
667
|
2039 be given anyway. This is useful when debugging 'foldexpr',
|
|
2040 'formatexpr' or 'indentexpr'.
|
168
|
2041 When set to "beep", a message will be given when otherwise only a beep
|
|
2042 would be produced.
|
|
2043 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
|
7
|
2044
|
|
2045 *'define'* *'def'*
|
|
2046 'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
|
|
2047 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
2048 {not in Vi}
|
10
|
2049 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
|
7
|
2050 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
|
|
2051 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
|
|
2052 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
|
|
2053 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
|
|
2054 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
|
|
2055 or backslash.
|
|
2056 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
|
|
2057 useful, to include const type declarations: >
|
|
2058 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
|
|
2059 < When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
|
|
2060
|
|
2061 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
|
|
2062 'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
|
|
2063 global
|
|
2064 {not in Vi}
|
|
2065 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
|
|
2066 feature}
|
|
2067 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
|
|
2068 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
|
|
2069 default) the character along with its combining characters are
|
|
2070 deleted.
|
|
2071 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"!
|
|
2072
|
|
2073 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
|
|
2074 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
|
|
2075 to remove only the combining ones.
|
|
2076
|
|
2077 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
|
|
2078 'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
|
|
2079 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
2080 {not in Vi}
|
|
2081 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
|
|
2082 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
|
|
2083 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
|
|
2084 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
|
|
2085 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
|
10
|
2086 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
|
7
|
2087 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
|
|
2088 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
|
99
|
2089 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
|
7
|
2090 Where to find a list of words?
|
|
2091 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
|
|
2092 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
|
|
2093 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
|
|
2094 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
|
|
2095 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
|
|
2096 uses another default.
|
|
2097 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
|
|
2098
|
|
2099 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
|
|
2100 'diff' boolean (default off)
|
|
2101 local to window
|
|
2102 {not in Vi}
|
|
2103 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
|
|
2104 feature}
|
|
2105 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
|
10
|
2106 between files. See |vimdiff|.
|
7
|
2107
|
|
2108 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
|
|
2109 'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
|
|
2110 global
|
|
2111 {not in Vi}
|
|
2112 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
|
|
2113 feature}
|
|
2114 Expression which is evaluated to obtain an ed-style diff file from two
|
|
2115 versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
|
|
2116 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
2117 security reasons.
|
|
2118
|
|
2119 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
|
|
2120 'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "filler")
|
|
2121 global
|
|
2122 {not in Vi}
|
|
2123 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
|
|
2124 feature}
|
10
|
2125 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
|
7
|
2126 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
|
|
2127
|
|
2128 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
|
|
2129 synchronized with a window that has inserted
|
|
2130 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
|
|
2131 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
|
|
2132 is set.
|
|
2133
|
|
2134 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
|
|
2135 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
|
|
2136 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
|
|
2137 See |fold-diff|.
|
|
2138
|
|
2139 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
|
|
2140 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
|
|
2141 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
|
|
2142
|
|
2143 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
|
|
2144 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
|
|
2145 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
|
|
2146 of the "diff" command for what this does
|
|
2147 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
|
|
2148 white space, but not leading white space.
|
|
2149
|
|
2150 Examples: >
|
|
2151
|
|
2152 :set diffopt=filler,context:4
|
|
2153 :set diffopt=
|
|
2154 :set diffopt=filler
|
|
2155 <
|
|
2156 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
|
|
2157 'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
|
|
2158 global
|
|
2159 {not in Vi}
|
|
2160 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
|
|
2161 feature}
|
|
2162 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
|
|
2163 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
|
|
2164 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
2165
|
|
2166 *'directory'* *'dir'*
|
|
2167 'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
|
|
2168 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
|
|
2169 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
|
|
2170 global
|
|
2171 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
|
|
2172 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
|
|
2173 possible.
|
|
2174 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
|
|
2175 impossible!).
|
|
2176 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
|
|
2177 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
|
|
2178 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
|
|
2179 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
|
33
|
2180 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
|
7
|
2181 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
|
|
2182 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
|
459
|
2183 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//"
|
|
2184 or "\\", the swap file name will be built from the complete path to
|
|
2185 the file with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs.
|
|
2186 This will ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
|
7
|
2187 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
|
|
2188 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
|
|
2189 name, precede it with a backslash.
|
|
2190 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
|
|
2191 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
|
|
2192 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
|
|
2193 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
|
|
2194 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
|
|
2195 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
|
|
2196 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
|
|
2197 of the option is removed.
|
|
2198 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
|
|
2199 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
|
|
2200 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
|
|
2201 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
|
|
2202 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap
|
|
2203 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your
|
|
2204 home directory is tried first.
|
|
2205 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
|
|
2206 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
|
|
2207 uses another default.
|
|
2208 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
2209 security reasons.
|
|
2210 {Vi: directory to put temp file in, defaults to "/tmp"}
|
|
2211
|
|
2212 *'display'* *'dy'*
|
|
2213 'display' 'dy' string (default "")
|
|
2214 global
|
|
2215 {not in Vi}
|
|
2216 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of
|
|
2217 flags:
|
|
2218 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
|
10
|
2219 in a window will be displayed. When not included, a
|
7
|
2220 last line that doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
|
|
2221 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
|
|
2222 instead of using ^C and ~C.
|
|
2223
|
|
2224 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
|
|
2225 'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
|
|
2226 global
|
|
2227 {not in Vi}
|
|
2228 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
|
|
2229 feature}
|
|
2230 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
|
|
2231 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
|
|
2232 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
|
|
2233 both width and height of windows is affected
|
|
2234
|
|
2235 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
|
|
2236 'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
|
|
2237 global
|
|
2238 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
|
|
2239 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
|
|
2240 also 'gdefault' option.
|
|
2241 Switching this option on is discouraged!
|
|
2242
|
|
2243 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
|
|
2244 'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG)
|
|
2245 global
|
|
2246 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
|
|
2247 feature}
|
|
2248 {not in Vi}
|
|
2249 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
|
|
2250 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
|
|
2251 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
|
|
2252 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
|
|
2253
|
|
2254 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
|
39
|
2255 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
|
7
|
2256 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
|
|
2257 starts up. See |multibyte|.
|
|
2258
|
|
2259 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' to
|
|
2260 "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
|
|
2261 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
|
|
2262 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
|
10
|
2263 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
|
7
|
2264 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
|
|
2265 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
|
|
2266
|
|
2267 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
|
10
|
2268 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
|
7
|
2269 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
|
|
2270
|
|
2271 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
|
|
2272 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
|
|
2273 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
|
|
2274 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
|
|
2275
|
|
2276 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
|
|
2277 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
|
|
2278
|
|
2279 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
|
|
2280 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
|
|
2281 to '-' signs.
|
|
2282 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
|
|
2283 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
|
|
2284 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
|
|
2285
|
|
2286 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
|
|
2287 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
|
|
2288 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
|
|
2289 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
|
|
2290 utf-8.
|
|
2291
|
|
2292 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
|
|
2293 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
|
|
2294 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
|
|
2295 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
|
|
2296 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
|
448
|
2297
|
|
2298 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
|
|
2299 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
|
7
|
2300
|
|
2301 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
|
|
2302 'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
|
|
2303 local to buffer
|
|
2304 {not in Vi}
|
|
2305 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
|
10
|
2306 is on, no <EOL> will be written for the last line in the file. This
|
7
|
2307 option is automatically set when starting to edit a new file, unless
|
|
2308 the file does not have an <EOL> for the last line in the file, in
|
|
2309 which case it is reset. Normally you don't have to set or reset this
|
|
2310 option. When 'binary' is off the value is not used when writing the
|
|
2311 file. When 'binary' is on it is used to remember the presence of a
|
|
2312 <EOL> for the last line in the file, so that when you write the file
|
|
2313 the situation from the original file can be kept. But you can change
|
|
2314 it if you want to.
|
|
2315
|
|
2316 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
|
|
2317 'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
|
|
2318 global
|
|
2319 {not in Vi}
|
|
2320 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
|
33
|
2321 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
|
|
2322 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
|
|
2323 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
|
|
2324 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
|
|
2325 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
|
7
|
2326 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
|
|
2327 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
|
|
2328 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
|
|
2329 Changing the height of a window can be avoided by setting
|
|
2330 'winfixheight'.
|
|
2331
|
|
2332 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
|
|
2333 'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
|
|
2334 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
2335 {not in Vi}
|
|
2336 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
|
|
2337 the internal formatting functions are used ('lisp', 'cindent' or
|
|
2338 'indentexpr').
|
10
|
2339 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
|
7
|
2340 about including spaces and backslashes.
|
|
2341 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
2342 security reasons.
|
|
2343
|
|
2344 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
|
|
2345 'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
|
|
2346 global
|
|
2347 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
|
|
2348 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
|
|
2349 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
|
10
|
2350 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
|
7
|
2351 screen flash or do nothing.
|
|
2352
|
|
2353 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
|
|
2354 'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
|
|
2355 others: "errors.err")
|
|
2356 global
|
|
2357 {not in Vi}
|
|
2358 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
|
|
2359 feature}
|
|
2360 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
|
|
2361 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
|
|
2362 following argument. See |-q|.
|
|
2363 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
|
|
2364 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
|
|
2365 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
|
|
2366 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
2367 security reasons.
|
|
2368
|
|
2369 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
|
|
2370 'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
|
|
2371 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
2372 {not in Vi}
|
|
2373 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
|
|
2374 feature}
|
|
2375 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
|
|
2376 (see |errorformat|).
|
|
2377
|
|
2378 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
|
|
2379 'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
|
|
2380 global
|
|
2381 {not in Vi}
|
|
2382 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
|
|
2383 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
|
|
2384 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
|
|
2385 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
|
|
2386 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
|
|
2387 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
|
|
2388 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
|
|
2389 won't work by default.
|
|
2390 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
2391 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
2392
|
|
2393 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
|
|
2394 'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
|
|
2395 global
|
|
2396 {not in Vi}
|
|
2397 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
|
|
2398 feature}
|
|
2399 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
|
|
2400 When set to "all", all autocommand events are ignored, autocommands
|
|
2401 will not be executed.
|
|
2402 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: >
|
|
2403 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
|
|
2404 <
|
|
2405 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
|
|
2406 'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
|
|
2407 local to buffer
|
|
2408 {not in Vi}
|
|
2409 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
|
10
|
2410 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
|
7
|
2411 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
|
|
2412 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
|
|
2413 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
2414
|
|
2415 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
|
|
2416 'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
|
|
2417 global
|
|
2418 {not in Vi}
|
|
2419 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
|
|
2420 directory. If you switch this option on you should also consider
|
|
2421 setting the 'secure' option (see |initialization|). Using a local
|
|
2422 .exrc, .vimrc or .gvimrc is a potential security leak, use with care!
|
|
2423 also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
|
|
2424 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
2425 security reasons.
|
|
2426
|
|
2427 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
|
|
2428 'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
|
|
2429 local to buffer
|
|
2430 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
|
|
2431 feature}
|
|
2432 {not in Vi}
|
|
2433 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
|
|
2434 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
|
|
2435 done when reading and writing the file.
|
|
2436 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
|
|
2437 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
|
|
2438 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
|
|
2439 'encoding' is "utf-8" conversion is most likely done in a way
|
|
2440 that the reverse conversion results in the same text. When
|
|
2441 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some characters may be lost!
|
|
2442 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
|
|
2443 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
|
|
2444 |mbyte-conversion|.
|
|
2445 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
|
|
2446 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
|
|
2447 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument.
|
|
2448 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
|
|
2449 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
|
|
2450 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
|
|
2451 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
|
|
2452 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
|
|
2453 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
|
|
2454 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
|
|
2455 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
|
|
2456 If you do this in a modeline, you might want to set 'nomodified' to
|
|
2457 avoid this.
|
|
2458 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
|
|
2459
|
|
2460 *'fe'*
|
|
2461 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
|
10
|
2462 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
|
7
|
2463 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
|
|
2464
|
|
2465 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
|
39
|
2466 'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
|
|
2467 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
|
|
2468 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
|
7
|
2469 global
|
|
2470 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
|
|
2471 feature}
|
|
2472 {not in Vi}
|
|
2473 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
|
|
2474 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
|
|
2475 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
|
|
2476 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
|
10
|
2477 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
|
7
|
2478 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
|
|
2479 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
|
|
2480 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
|
|
2481 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
|
|
2482 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
|
596
|
2483 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use
|
|
2484 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters
|
|
2485 that can't be converted.
|
7
|
2486 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
|
|
2487 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
|
|
2488 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
|
|
2489 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
|
|
2490 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
|
|
2491 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
|
|
2492 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
|
|
2493 < This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
|
|
2494 non-blank characters.
|
596
|
2495 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is
|
|
2496 not used.
|
|
2497 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, 'fileencoding'
|
7
|
2498 is always empty then. This means that a non-existing file may get a
|
|
2499 different encoding than an empty file.
|
|
2500 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
|
|
2501 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
|
|
2502 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
|
|
2503 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
|
|
2504 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
|
|
2505 accepted.
|
39
|
2506 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
|
|
2507 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful
|
|
2508 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a
|
|
2509 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian.
|
7
|
2510 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
|
|
2511 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
|
|
2512 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
|
|
2513 file
|
|
2514 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
|
|
2515 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
|
|
2516 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
|
|
2517 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
|
|
2518 is read.
|
|
2519
|
|
2520 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
|
|
2521 'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-DOS, MS-Windows, OS/2 default: "dos",
|
|
2522 Unix default: "unix",
|
|
2523 Macintosh default: "mac")
|
|
2524 local to buffer
|
|
2525 {not in Vi}
|
|
2526 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
|
|
2527 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
|
|
2528 dos <CR> <NL>
|
|
2529 unix <NL>
|
|
2530 mac <CR>
|
|
2531 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
|
|
2532 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
|
|
2533 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
|
|
2534 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
|
|
2535 works like it was set to "unix'.
|
|
2536 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
|
|
2537 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
|
|
2538 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
|
|
2539 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
|
|
2540 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
|
|
2541 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
|
|
2542 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
|
|
2543
|
|
2544 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
|
|
2545 'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
|
|
2546 Vim+Vi MS-DOS, MS-Windows OS/2: "dos,unix",
|
|
2547 Vim Unix: "unix,dos",
|
|
2548 Vim Mac: "mac,unix,dos",
|
|
2549 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
|
|
2550 Vi others: "")
|
|
2551 global
|
|
2552 {not in Vi}
|
|
2553 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
|
|
2554 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
|
|
2555 buffer:
|
|
2556 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
|
|
2557 always. It is not set automatically.
|
|
2558 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
|
10
|
2559 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
|
7
|
2560 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
|
|
2561 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
|
|
2562 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
|
|
2563 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
|
|
2564 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
|
|
2565 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
|
|
2566 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
|
|
2567 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
|
10
|
2568 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
|
7
|
2569 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
|
|
2570 3. If 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
|
|
2571 This means that "mac" is only chosen when "unix" is not present,
|
|
2572 or when no <NL> is found in the file, and when "dos" is not
|
|
2573 present, or no <CR><NL> is present in the file.
|
|
2574 Also if "unix" was first chosen, but the first <CR> is before
|
|
2575 the first <NL> and there appears to be more <CR>'s than <NL>'s in
|
|
2576 the file, then 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
|
|
2577 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
|
|
2578 'fileformats' is used.
|
|
2579 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
|
|
2580 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
|
|
2581 file only, the option is not changed.
|
|
2582 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
|
|
2583
|
|
2584 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
|
|
2585 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
|
|
2586 done:
|
|
2587 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
|
|
2588 format will be used.
|
|
2589 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
|
|
2590 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
|
|
2591 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
|
|
2592 used.
|
|
2593 Also see |file-formats|.
|
|
2594 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
|
|
2595 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
|
|
2596 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
|
|
2597 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
2598 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
2599
|
|
2600 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
|
|
2601 'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
|
|
2602 local to buffer
|
|
2603 {not in Vi}
|
|
2604 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
|
|
2605 feature}
|
|
2606 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
|
|
2607 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
|
|
2608 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
|
|
2609 name.
|
|
2610 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
|
|
2611 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
|
|
2612 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
|
|
2613 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
|
|
2614 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
|
|
2615 Example, for in an IDL file: >
|
|
2616 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */
|
|
2617 < |FileType| |filetypes|
|
|
2618 Do not confuse this option with 'osfiletype', which is for the file
|
|
2619 type that is actually stored with the file.
|
|
2620 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
|
|
2621 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
|
36
|
2622 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
|
7
|
2623
|
|
2624 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
|
|
2625 'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-")
|
|
2626 global
|
|
2627 {not in Vi}
|
|
2628 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
|
|
2629 and |+folding| features}
|
|
2630 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators.
|
|
2631 It is a comma separated list of items:
|
|
2632
|
|
2633 item default Used for ~
|
|
2634 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window
|
|
2635 stlnc:c ' ' or '-' statusline of the non-current windows
|
|
2636 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
|
|
2637 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext'
|
|
2638 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
|
|
2639
|
10
|
2640 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and
|
7
|
2641 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '-'
|
|
2642 otherwise.
|
|
2643
|
|
2644 Example: >
|
|
2645 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:-,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-
|
|
2646 < This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also
|
|
2647 be used when there is highlighting.
|
|
2648
|
|
2649 The highlighting used for these items:
|
|
2650 item highlight group ~
|
|
2651 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
|
|
2652 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
|
|
2653 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
|
|
2654 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded|
|
|
2655 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
|
|
2656
|
|
2657 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
|
|
2658 'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198*
|
|
2659 global
|
|
2660 {not in Vi}
|
|
2661 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
|
|
2662 feature}
|
|
2663 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Farsi character set.
|
|
2664 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
|
10
|
2665 toggle this option |i_CTRL-_|. See |farsi.txt|.
|
7
|
2666
|
|
2667 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
|
|
2668 'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
|
|
2669 global
|
|
2670 {not in Vi}
|
|
2671 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2672 feature}
|
|
2673 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
|
|
2674 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
|
|
2675 automatically close when moving out of them.
|
|
2676
|
|
2677 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
|
|
2678 'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
|
|
2679 local to window
|
|
2680 {not in Vi}
|
|
2681 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2682 feature}
|
|
2683 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
|
|
2684 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
|
|
2685 value is 12.
|
|
2686 See |folding|.
|
|
2687
|
|
2688 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
|
|
2689 'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
|
|
2690 local to window
|
|
2691 {not in Vi}
|
|
2692 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2693 feature}
|
|
2694 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
|
|
2695 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
|
|
2696 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
|
10
|
2697 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
|
7
|
2698 'foldenable' is off.
|
|
2699 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
|
|
2700 See |folding|.
|
|
2701
|
|
2702 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
|
|
2703 'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
|
|
2704 local to window
|
|
2705 {not in Vi}
|
|
2706 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2707 or |+eval| feature}
|
|
2708 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
|
634
|
2709 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|.
|
|
2710
|
|
2711 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
|
2712 |sandbox-option|.
|
|
2713
|
|
2714 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
|
2715 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|.
|
7
|
2716
|
|
2717 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
|
|
2718 'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
|
|
2719 local to window
|
|
2720 {not in Vi}
|
|
2721 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2722 feature}
|
|
2723 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
|
|
2724 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
|
10
|
2725 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
|
7
|
2726 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
|
|
2727
|
|
2728 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
|
|
2729 'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
|
|
2730 local to window
|
|
2731 {not in Vi}
|
|
2732 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2733 feature}
|
|
2734 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
|
|
2735 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
|
|
2736 close fewer folds.
|
|
2737 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
|
|
2738 See |fold-foldlevel|.
|
|
2739
|
|
2740 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
|
|
2741 'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
|
|
2742 global
|
|
2743 {not in Vi}
|
|
2744 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2745 feature}
|
|
2746 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
|
|
2747 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
|
|
2748 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
|
|
2749 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
|
10
|
2750 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
|
7
|
2751 ignores this option and closes all folds.
|
|
2752 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
|
|
2753 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
|
|
2754 When the value is negative, it is not used.
|
|
2755
|
|
2756 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
|
|
2757 'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
|
|
2758 local to window
|
|
2759 {not in Vi}
|
|
2760 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2761 feature}
|
|
2762 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
|
|
2763 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
|
|
2764 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
|
|
2765 See |fold-marker|.
|
|
2766
|
|
2767 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
|
|
2768 'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
|
|
2769 local to window
|
|
2770 {not in Vi}
|
|
2771 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2772 feature}
|
|
2773 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
|
|
2774 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
|
|
2775 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
|
|
2776 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
|
|
2777 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
|
|
2778 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
|
|
2779 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
|
|
2780
|
|
2781 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
|
|
2782 'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
|
|
2783 local to window
|
|
2784 {not in Vi}
|
|
2785 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2786 feature}
|
|
2787 Sets the minimum number of screen lines for a fold to be displayed
|
|
2788 closed. Also for manually closed folds.
|
|
2789 Note that this only has an effect of what is displayed. After using
|
|
2790 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
|
|
2791 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
|
|
2792
|
|
2793 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
|
|
2794 'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
|
|
2795 local to window
|
|
2796 {not in Vi}
|
|
2797 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2798 feature}
|
|
2799 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
|
|
2800 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
|
|
2801 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
|
|
2802
|
|
2803 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
|
|
2804 'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
|
|
2805 search,tag,undo")
|
|
2806 global
|
|
2807 {not in Vi}
|
|
2808 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2809 feature}
|
|
2810 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
|
|
2811 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated
|
|
2812 list of items.
|
|
2813 item commands ~
|
|
2814 all any
|
|
2815 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
|
|
2816 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
|
|
2817 insert any command in Insert mode
|
|
2818 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
|
|
2819 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
|
|
2820 percent "%"
|
|
2821 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
|
|
2822 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
|
|
2823 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
|
|
2824 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
|
|
2825 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
|
10
|
2826 When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used. Add
|
7
|
2827 the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
|
|
2828 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
|
|
2829 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
|
|
2830 whole closed fold.
|
|
2831 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
|
|
2832 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
|
|
2833 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
|
|
2834 when text is inserted.
|
|
2835 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
|
|
2836 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
|
|
2837
|
|
2838 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
|
|
2839 'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
|
|
2840 local to window
|
|
2841 {not in Vi}
|
|
2842 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
|
|
2843 feature}
|
|
2844 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
|
|
2845 fold. See |fold-foldtext|.
|
|
2846
|
634
|
2847 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
|
2848 |sandbox-option|.
|
|
2849
|
|
2850 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
|
2851 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
|
|
2852
|
7
|
2853 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
|
|
2854 'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
|
|
2855 local to buffer
|
|
2856 {not in Vi}
|
|
2857 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
|
|
2858 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is
|
|
2859 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can
|
|
2860 be inserted for readability.
|
|
2861 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
|
|
2862 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
|
|
2863 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
2864 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
2865
|
41
|
2866 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
|
|
2867 'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
|
|
2868 local to buffer
|
|
2869 {not in Vi}
|
|
2870 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
|
|
2871 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
|
|
2872 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
|
140
|
2873 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
|
41
|
2874 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
|
|
2875 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
|
|
2876 like there is no match.
|
|
2877 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
|
|
2878 character and white space.
|
|
2879
|
7
|
2880 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
|
|
2881 'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
|
|
2882 global
|
|
2883 {not in Vi}
|
|
2884 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
|
667
|
2885 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on
|
7
|
2886 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
|
557
|
2887 such a program.
|
667
|
2888 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead.
|
|
2889 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal
|
|
2890 format function will be used |C-indenting|.
|
557
|
2891 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
|
|
2892 about including spaces and backslashes.
|
667
|
2893 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
|
2894 |sandbox-option|.
|
|
2895
|
|
2896 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
|
|
2897 'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
|
|
2898 local to buffer
|
|
2899 {not in Vi}
|
|
2900 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
|
|
2901 feature}
|
|
2902 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq|
|
|
2903 operator. The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted,
|
|
2904 |v:count| the number of lines to be formatted.
|
|
2905 When this option is empty 'formatprg' is used.
|
|
2906 Example: >
|
|
2907 :set formatexp=mylang#Format()
|
|
2908 < This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the
|
|
2909 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload|
|
|
2910
|
|
2911 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding
|
|
2912 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as
|
|
2913 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the
|
|
2914 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will
|
|
2915 return "i" or "R" in this situation. When the function returns
|
|
2916 non-zero Vim will fall back to using the internal format mechanism.
|
|
2917
|
|
2918 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
|
2919 |sandbox-option|.
|
|
2920
|
|
2921 *'fsync'* *'fs'*
|
36
|
2922 'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
|
|
2923 global
|
|
2924 {not in Vi}
|
|
2925 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
|
|
2926 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
|
|
2927 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
|
|
2928 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
|
|
2929 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
|
|
2930 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
|
|
2931 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
|
|
2932 off.
|
|
2933 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
|
|
2934
|
7
|
2935 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
|
|
2936 'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
|
|
2937 global
|
|
2938 {not in Vi}
|
|
2939 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
|
|
2940 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
|
|
2941 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
|
|
2942 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
|
|
2943
|
|
2944 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
|
|
2945 :s/// subst. all subst. one
|
|
2946 :s///g subst. one subst. all
|
|
2947 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
|
|
2948
|
|
2949 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
2950
|
|
2951 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
|
|
2952 'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
|
|
2953 global
|
|
2954 {not in Vi}
|
|
2955 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
|
|
2956 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
|
|
2957 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
|
|
2958
|
|
2959 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
|
|
2960 'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
|
|
2961 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
|
|
2962 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
|
|
2963 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
|
|
2964 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
2965 {not in Vi}
|
233
|
2966 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
|
7
|
2967 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
|
|
2968 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
|
|
2969 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
|
|
2970 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
|
|
2971 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
|
|
2972 also work well with a single file: >
|
|
2973 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
|
161
|
2974 < Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
|
657
|
2975 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like
|
|
2976 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|.
|
41
|
2977 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
|
7
|
2978 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
|
|
2979 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
|
|
2980 otherwise it's "grep -n".
|
|
2981 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
2982 security reasons.
|
|
2983
|
|
2984 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
|
|
2985 'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
|
|
2986 ve:ver35-Cursor,
|
|
2987 o:hor50-Cursor,
|
|
2988 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
|
|
2989 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
|
|
2990 sm:block-Cursor
|
|
2991 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
|
|
2992 for MS-DOS and Win32 console:
|
|
2993 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
|
|
2994 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
|
|
2995 global
|
|
2996 {not in Vi}
|
|
2997 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
|
|
2998 for MS-DOS and Win32 console}
|
|
2999 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
|
10
|
3000 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only
|
7
|
3001 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by
|
|
3002 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or
|
|
3003 horizontal cursor.
|
36
|
3004 For a console the 't_SI' and 't_EI' escape sequences are used.
|
7
|
3005
|
10
|
3006 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
|
7
|
3007 mode-list and an argument-list:
|
|
3008 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
|
|
3009 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
|
|
3010 n Normal mode
|
|
3011 v Visual mode
|
|
3012 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
|
|
3013 if not specified)
|
|
3014 o Operator-pending mode
|
|
3015 i Insert mode
|
|
3016 r Replace mode
|
|
3017 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
|
|
3018 ci Command-line Insert mode
|
|
3019 cr Command-line Replace mode
|
|
3020 sm showmatch in Insert mode
|
|
3021 a all modes
|
|
3022 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
|
|
3023 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
|
|
3024 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
|
|
3025 block block cursor, fills the whole character
|
|
3026 [only one of the above three should be present]
|
|
3027 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
|
|
3028 blinkon{N}
|
|
3029 blinkoff{N}
|
|
3030 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
|
|
3031 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
|
|
3032 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
|
|
3033 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
|
|
3034 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
|
|
3035 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
|
|
3036 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
|
|
3037 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
|
|
3038 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
|
|
3039 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
|
|
3040 executing a command.
|
|
3041 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
|
|
3042 |xterm-blink|.
|
|
3043 {group-name}
|
|
3044 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
|
|
3045 for the cursor
|
|
3046 {group-name}/{group-name}
|
|
3047 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
|
|
3048 no language mappings are used, the other when they
|
|
3049 are. |language-mapping|
|
|
3050
|
|
3051 Examples of parts:
|
|
3052 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
|
|
3053 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
|
|
3054 highlight group
|
|
3055 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
|
|
3056 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
|
|
3057 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
|
|
3058 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
|
|
3059 faster.
|
|
3060
|
|
3061 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
|
|
3062 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
|
|
3063 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
|
|
3064 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
|
|
3065
|
|
3066 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
|
|
3067 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
|
|
3068 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
|
|
3069 <
|
|
3070 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
|
|
3071 *E235* *E596* *E610* *E611*
|
|
3072 'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
|
|
3073 global
|
|
3074 {not in Vi}
|
|
3075 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
|
|
3076 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
|
|
3077 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. When
|
|
3078 the font cannot be found you will get an error message. To try other
|
|
3079 font names a list can be specified, font names separated with commas.
|
|
3080 The first valid font is used.
|
8
|
3081
|
170
|
3082 On systems where 'guifontset' is supported (X11) and 'guifontset' is
|
|
3083 not empty, then 'guifont' is not used.
|
8
|
3084
|
7
|
3085 Spaces after a comma are ignored. To include a comma in a font name
|
|
3086 precede it with a backslash. Setting an option requires an extra
|
|
3087 backslash before a space and a backslash. See also
|
|
3088 |option-backslash|. For example: >
|
|
3089 :set guifont=Screen15,\ 7x13,font\\,with\\,commas
|
8
|
3090 < will make Vim try to use the font "Screen15" first, and if it fails it
|
7
|
3091 will try to use "7x13" and then "font,with,commas" instead.
|
8
|
3092
|
|
3093 If none of the fonts can be loaded, Vim will keep the current setting.
|
|
3094 If an empty font list is given, Vim will try using other resource
|
|
3095 settings (for X, it will use the Vim.font resource), and finally it
|
|
3096 will try some builtin default which should always be there ("7x13" in
|
|
3097 the case of X). The font names given should be "normal" fonts. Vim
|
|
3098 will try to find the related bold and italic fonts.
|
|
3099
|
170
|
3100 For Win32, GTK, Mac OS and Photon: >
|
8
|
3101 :set guifont=*
|
|
3102 < will bring up a font requester, where you can pick the font you want.
|
|
3103
|
|
3104 The font name depends on the GUI used. See |setting-guifont| for a
|
|
3105 way to set 'guifont' for various systems.
|
|
3106
|
7
|
3107 For the GTK+ 2 GUI the font name looks like this: >
|
|
3108 :set guifont=Andale\ Mono\ 11
|
|
3109 < That's all. XLFDs are no longer accepted.
|
170
|
3110
|
|
3111 For Mac OSX you can use something like this: >
|
|
3112 :set guifont=Monaco:h10
|
|
3113 < *E236*
|
7
|
3114 Note that the fonts must be mono-spaced (all characters have the same
|
8
|
3115 width). An exception is GTK 2: all fonts are accepted, but
|
|
3116 mono-spaced fonts look best.
|
|
3117
|
7
|
3118 To preview a font on X11, you might be able to use the "xfontsel"
|
|
3119 program. The "xlsfonts" program gives a list of all available fonts.
|
8
|
3120
|
7
|
3121 For the Win32 GUI *E244* *E245*
|
|
3122 - takes these options in the font name:
|
|
3123 hXX - height is XX (points, can be floating-point)
|
|
3124 wXX - width is XX (points, can be floating-point)
|
|
3125 b - bold
|
|
3126 i - italic
|
|
3127 u - underline
|
|
3128 s - strikeout
|
233
|
3129 cXX - character set XX. Valid charsets are: ANSI, ARABIC,
|
7
|
3130 BALTIC, CHINESEBIG5, DEFAULT, EASTEUROPE, GB2312, GREEK,
|
|
3131 HANGEUL, HEBREW, JOHAB, MAC, OEM, RUSSIAN, SHIFTJIS,
|
|
3132 SYMBOL, THAI, TURKISH, VIETNAMESE ANSI and BALTIC.
|
22
|
3133 Normally you would use "cDEFAULT".
|
7
|
3134
|
|
3135 Use a ':' to separate the options.
|
|
3136 - A '_' can be used in the place of a space, so you don't need to use
|
|
3137 backslashes to escape the spaces.
|
|
3138 - Examples: >
|
|
3139 :set guifont=courier_new:h12:w5:b:cRUSSIAN
|
|
3140 :set guifont=Andale_Mono:h7.5:w4.5
|
|
3141 < See also |font-sizes|.
|
|
3142
|
|
3143 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
|
|
3144 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
|
|
3145 'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
|
|
3146 global
|
|
3147 {not in Vi}
|
|
3148 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
|
|
3149 with the |+xfontset| feature}
|
|
3150 {not available in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
|
|
3151 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
|
|
3152 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
|
|
3153 |xfontset|.
|
|
3154 Setting this option also means that all font names will be handled as
|
|
3155 a fontset name. Also the ones used for the "font" argument of the
|
|
3156 |:highlight| command.
|
|
3157 The fonts must match with the current locale. If fonts for the
|
|
3158 character sets that the current locale uses are not included, setting
|
|
3159 'guifontset' will fail.
|
|
3160 Note the difference between 'guifont' and 'guifontset': In 'guifont'
|
|
3161 the comma-separated names are alternative names, one of which will be
|
|
3162 used. In 'guifontset' the whole string is one fontset name,
|
|
3163 including the commas. It is not possible to specify alternative
|
|
3164 fontset names.
|
|
3165 This example works on many X11 systems: >
|
|
3166 :set guifontset=-*-*-medium-r-normal--16-*-*-*-c-*-*-*
|
|
3167 <
|
|
3168 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
|
|
3169 'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
|
|
3170 global
|
|
3171 {not in Vi}
|
|
3172 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
|
|
3173 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
|
|
3174 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
|
|
3175 used.
|
|
3176 Note: The size of these fonts must be exactly twice as wide as the one
|
|
3177 specified with 'guifont' and the same height.
|
|
3178
|
|
3179 All GUI versions but GTK+ 2:
|
|
3180
|
|
3181 'guifontwide' is only used when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and
|
|
3182 'guifontset' is empty or invalid.
|
|
3183 When 'guifont' is set and a valid font is found in it and
|
|
3184 'guifontwide' is empty Vim will attempt to find a matching
|
|
3185 double-width font and set 'guifontwide' to it.
|
|
3186
|
|
3187 GTK+ 2 GUI only: *guifontwide_gtk2*
|
|
3188
|
|
3189 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is always used for double width
|
|
3190 characters, even if 'encoding' is not set to "utf-8".
|
|
3191 Vim does not attempt to find an appropriate value for 'guifontwide'
|
10
|
3192 automatically. If 'guifontwide' is empty Pango/Xft will choose the
|
7
|
3193 font for characters not available in 'guifont'. Thus you do not need
|
|
3194 to set 'guifontwide' at all unless you want to override the choice
|
|
3195 made by Pango/Xft.
|
|
3196
|
|
3197 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
|
|
3198 'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
|
|
3199 global
|
|
3200 {not in Vi} {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
|
|
3201 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
|
|
3202 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
|
|
3203 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
|
10
|
3204 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
|
7
|
3205 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
|
|
3206 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
|
|
3207 screen.
|
|
3208
|
|
3209 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
|
|
3210 'guioptions' 'go' string (default "gmrLtT" (MS-Windows),
|
233
|
3211 "agimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena))
|
7
|
3212 global
|
|
3213 {not in Vi}
|
|
3214 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
|
8
|
3215 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
|
7
|
3216 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
|
|
3217 GUI should be used.
|
|
3218 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
|
|
3219 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
|
|
3220
|
|
3221 Valid letters are as follows:
|
|
3222 *guioptions_a*
|
|
3223 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
|
|
3224 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
|
|
3225 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
|
|
3226 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
|
|
3227 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
|
|
3228 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
|
|
3229 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
|
|
3230 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
|
|
3231 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
|
|
3232 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
|
|
3233 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
|
|
3234 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
|
|
3235 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
|
|
3236 The same applies to the modeless selection.
|
|
3237
|
10
|
3238 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
|
7
|
3239 applies to the modeless selection.
|
|
3240
|
|
3241 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
|
|
3242 "" - -
|
|
3243 "a" yes yes
|
|
3244 "A" - yes
|
|
3245 "aA" yes yes
|
|
3246
|
|
3247 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
|
|
3248 choices.
|
|
3249
|
|
3250 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
|
|
3251 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
|
|
3252 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
|
|
3253 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
|
|
3254 foreground. |gui-fork|
|
|
3255 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
|
|
3256 happened already when the gvimrc file is read.
|
|
3257
|
|
3258 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
|
|
3259 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
|
|
3260 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
|
|
3261
|
|
3262 'm' Menu bar is present.
|
10
|
3263 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
|
7
|
3264 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
|
|
3265 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the .gvimrc
|
|
3266 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
|
|
3267 ":syntax on" and ":filetype on" commands load the menu too).
|
|
3268 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
|
|
3269 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
|
|
3270 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items.
|
|
3271
|
|
3272 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
|
|
3273 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
|
236
|
3274 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon
|
|
3275 and Athena GUIs.
|
7
|
3276
|
|
3277 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
|
|
3278 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
|
|
3279 split window.
|
|
3280 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
|
|
3281 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
|
|
3282 split window.
|
|
3283 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
|
|
3284 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
|
|
3285 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
|
|
3286 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
|
|
3287 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
|
|
3288
|
|
3289 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
|
|
3290 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
|
|
3291
|
|
3292 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
|
|
3293 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
|
|
3294 vertical layout is used anyway.
|
|
3295 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
|
|
3296 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
|
|
3297 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
|
|
3298 before starting the GUI. Set it in your gvimrc. Adding or
|
|
3299 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
|
10
|
3300 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
|
7
|
3301
|
|
3302 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
|
|
3303 'guipty' boolean (default on)
|
|
3304 global
|
|
3305 {not in Vi}
|
|
3306 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
|
|
3307 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
|
|
3308 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
|
|
3309
|
|
3310 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
|
|
3311 'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
|
|
3312 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
|
|
3313 global
|
|
3314 {not in Vi}
|
|
3315 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
|
|
3316 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
|
|
3317 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
|
|
3318 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
|
|
3319 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
|
10
|
3320 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
|
7
|
3321 spaces and backslashes.
|
|
3322 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
3323 security reasons.
|
|
3324
|
|
3325 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
|
|
3326 'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
|
|
3327 global
|
|
3328 {not in Vi}
|
|
3329 {not available when compiled without the +windows
|
|
3330 feature}
|
|
3331 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
|
|
3332 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
|
|
3333 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
|
|
3334 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
|
|
3335 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
|
|
3336
|
|
3337 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
|
|
3338 'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
|
|
3339 global
|
|
3340 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
|
|
3341 feature}
|
|
3342 {not in Vi}
|
|
3343 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
|
|
3344 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
|
|
3345 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
|
|
3346 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
|
|
3347 language and not in the English help.
|
|
3348 Example: >
|
|
3349 :set helplang=de,it
|
|
3350 < This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
|
|
3351 files.
|
|
3352 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
|
|
3353 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
|
|
3354 See |help-translated|.
|
|
3355
|
|
3356 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
|
|
3357 'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
|
|
3358 global
|
|
3359 {not in Vi}
|
|
3360 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
|
|
3361 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
|
|
3362 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
|
|
3363 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
|
|
3364 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is
|
|
3365 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!'
|
10
|
3366 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|.
|
12
|
3367 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
|
7
|
3368 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
|
|
3369 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
|
|
3370 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
|
|
3371
|
|
3372 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
|
|
3373 'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
|
|
3374 "8:SpecialKey,@:NonText,d:Directory,
|
|
3375 e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,l:Search,m:MoreMsg,
|
|
3376 M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,r:Question,
|
|
3377 s:StatusLine,S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit
|
|
3378 t:Title,v:Visual,w:WarningMsg,W:WildMenu,
|
|
3379 f:Folded,F:FoldColumn,A:DiffAdd,
|
|
3380 C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete,T:DiffText,
|
386
|
3381 >:SignColumn,B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,
|
540
|
3382 R:SpellRare,L:SpellLocal,
|
|
3383 +:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel,
|
|
3384 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb")
|
7
|
3385 global
|
|
3386 {not in Vi}
|
|
3387 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
|
|
3388 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The
|
|
3389 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
|
10
|
3390 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
|
7
|
3391 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
|
|
3392 |hl-NonText| @ '~' and '@' at the end of the window and
|
|
3393 characters from 'showbreak'
|
|
3394 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
|
|
3395 things in listings
|
|
3396 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
|
|
3397 h (obsolete, ignored)
|
|
3398 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
|
|
3399 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
|
|
3400 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
|
|
3401 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
|
|
3402 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands
|
|
3403 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
|
|
3404 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
|
|
3405 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
|
|
3406 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
|
|
3407 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
|
|
3408 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
|
|
3409 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
|
|
3410 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
|
|
3411 |xterm-clipboard|.
|
|
3412 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
|
|
3413 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
|
|
3414 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
|
|
3415 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
|
386
|
3416 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
|
|
3417 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
|
|
3418 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
|
|
3419 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode
|
7
|
3420 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
|
221
|
3421 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
|
386
|
3422 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital|spell|
|
221
|
3423 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
|
|
3424 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
|
540
|
3425 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line
|
|
3426 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu normal line
|
|
3427 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar
|
|
3428 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb
|
7
|
3429
|
|
3430 The display modes are:
|
|
3431 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
|
|
3432 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
|
|
3433 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
|
|
3434 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
|
|
3435 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
|
205
|
3436 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce")
|
7
|
3437 n no highlighting
|
|
3438 - no highlighting
|
|
3439 : use a highlight group
|
|
3440 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
|
|
3441 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
|
|
3442 for an example.
|
|
3443 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
|
|
3444 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
|
|
3445 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
|
|
3446 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
|
|
3447 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
|
|
3448
|
|
3449 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
|
|
3450 'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
|
|
3451 global
|
|
3452 {not in Vi}
|
|
3453 {not available when compiled without the
|
|
3454 |+extra_search| feature}
|
|
3455 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
|
|
3456 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
|
|
3457 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
|
|
3458 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
|
|
3459 are not applied.
|
|
3460 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
|
|
3461 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
|
|
3462 off with |:nohlsearch|. As soon as you use a search command, the
|
|
3463 highlighting comes back.
|
|
3464 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
|
|
3465 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
|
10
|
3466 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
|
7
|
3467 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
|
|
3468 drawn may not continue in an newly drawn line.
|
|
3469 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
3470
|
|
3471 *'history'* *'hi'*
|
|
3472 'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 20, Vi default: 0)
|
|
3473 global
|
|
3474 {not in Vi}
|
|
3475 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
|
|
3476 are remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
|
|
3477 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|).
|
|
3478 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
3479 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
3480
|
|
3481 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
|
|
3482 'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
|
|
3483 global
|
|
3484 {not in Vi}
|
|
3485 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
|
|
3486 feature}
|
|
3487 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
|
|
3488 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
|
|
3489 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
|
|
3490 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
3491
|
|
3492 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
|
|
3493 'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
|
|
3494 global
|
|
3495 {not in Vi}
|
|
3496 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
|
|
3497 feature}
|
|
3498 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
|
|
3499 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
|
|
3500 See |rileft.txt|.
|
|
3501 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
3502
|
|
3503 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
|
|
3504 'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
|
|
3505 global
|
|
3506 {not in Vi}
|
|
3507 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
|
|
3508 feature}
|
|
3509 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
|
|
3510 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
|
|
3511 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
|
|
3512 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
|
|
3513 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
|
|
3514 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
|
|
3515 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
|
|
3516 builtin termcap).
|
|
3517 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
|
233
|
3518 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
|
7
|
3519 X11.
|
|
3520
|
|
3521 *'iconstring'*
|
|
3522 'iconstring' string (default "")
|
|
3523 global
|
|
3524 {not in Vi}
|
|
3525 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
|
|
3526 feature}
|
|
3527 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
|
|
3528 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
|
|
3529 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
|
|
3530 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
|
|
3531 Does not work for MS Windows.
|
|
3532 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
|
|
3533 restored if possible |X11|.
|
|
3534 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
|
10
|
3535 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
|
7
|
3536 'titlestring' for example settings.
|
|
3537 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
|
|
3538
|
|
3539 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
|
|
3540 'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
|
|
3541 global
|
|
3542 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags
|
|
3543 file.
|
|
3544 Also see 'smartcase'.
|
|
3545 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
|
|
3546 |/ignorecase|.
|
|
3547
|
|
3548 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
|
|
3549 'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
|
|
3550 global
|
|
3551 {not in Vi}
|
|
3552 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
|
|
3553 |+GUI_GTK|}
|
|
3554 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
|
|
3555 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
|
|
3556 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
|
|
3557 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
|
|
3558 tells Vim what the key is.
|
|
3559 Format:
|
|
3560 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
|
|
3561
|
|
3562 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
|
|
3563 S Shift key
|
|
3564 L Lock key
|
|
3565 C Control key
|
|
3566 1 Mod1 key
|
|
3567 2 Mod2 key
|
|
3568 3 Mod3 key
|
|
3569 4 Mod4 key
|
|
3570 5 Mod5 key
|
|
3571 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
|
|
3572 both shift+ctrl+space.
|
|
3573 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
|
|
3574
|
|
3575 Example: >
|
|
3576 :set imactivatekey=S-space
|
|
3577 < "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
|
|
3578 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
|
|
3579
|
|
3580 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
|
|
3581 'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
|
|
3582 global
|
|
3583 {not in Vi}
|
|
3584 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|
|
|
3585 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| feature}
|
|
3586 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
|
|
3587 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
|
|
3588 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
|
|
3589 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
|
|
3590 characters with dead keys.
|
|
3591
|
|
3592 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'nodisable'* *'noimd'*
|
|
3593 'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
|
|
3594 global
|
|
3595 {not in Vi}
|
|
3596 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|
|
|
3597 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| feature}
|
|
3598 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
|
|
3599 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
|
|
3600 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
|
|
3601 may change in later releases.
|
|
3602
|
|
3603 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
|
|
3604 'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
|
|
3605 local to buffer
|
|
3606 {not in Vi}
|
|
3607 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
|
|
3608 Insert mode. Valid values:
|
|
3609 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
|
|
3610 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
|
|
3611 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
|
|
3612 2 is available only when compiled with the |+multi_byte_ime|, |+xim|
|
|
3613 or |global-ime|.
|
|
3614 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
|
|
3615 this can be used: >
|
|
3616 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
|
|
3617 < This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
|
|
3618 mode.
|
|
3619 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
|
|
3620 |i_CTRL-^|.
|
|
3621 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
|
|
3622 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
|
|
3623 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
|
|
3624 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
|
|
3625
|
|
3626 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
|
|
3627 'imsearch' 'ims' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
|
|
3628 local to buffer
|
|
3629 {not in Vi}
|
|
3630 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
|
|
3631 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
|
|
3632 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
|
|
3633 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
|
|
3634 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
|
|
3635 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
|
|
3636 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
|
|
3637 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
|
|
3638 |c_CTRL-^|.
|
|
3639 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
|
|
3640 option to a valid keymap name.
|
|
3641 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
|
|
3642 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
|
|
3643
|
|
3644 *'include'* *'inc'*
|
|
3645 'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
|
|
3646 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
3647 {not in Vi}
|
|
3648 {not available when compiled without the
|
|
3649 |+find_in_path| feature}
|
10
|
3650 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
|
7
|
3651 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
|
|
3652 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
|
532
|
3653 "]I", "[d", etc.
|
|
3654 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that
|
534
|
3655 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern
|
|
3656 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it
|
|
3657 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters
|
|
3658 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use
|
|
3659 'includeexpr' to process the matched text.
|
532
|
3660 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
|
7
|
3661
|
|
3662 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
|
|
3663 'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
|
|
3664 local to buffer
|
|
3665 {not in Vi}
|
|
3666 {not available when compiled without the
|
|
3667 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| feature}
|
|
3668 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
|
10
|
3669 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
|
7
|
3670 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
|
|
3671 < The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
|
634
|
3672
|
7
|
3673 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
|
10
|
3674 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
|
7
|
3675 Also used for |<cfile>|.
|
|
3676
|
634
|
3677 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
|
3678 |sandbox-option|.
|
|
3679
|
|
3680 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
|
3681 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
|
|
3682
|
7
|
3683 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
|
|
3684 'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off)
|
|
3685 global
|
|
3686 {not in Vi}
|
|
3687 {not available when compiled without the
|
|
3688 |+extra_search| feature}
|
17
|
3689 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
|
|
3690 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
|
|
3691 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
|
|
3692 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
|
|
3693 Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
|
|
3694 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
|
|
3695 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
|
|
3696 cursor to the match.
|
|
3697 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
|
|
3698 See also: 'hlsearch'.
|
7
|
3699 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
3700
|
|
3701 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
|
|
3702 'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
|
|
3703 local to buffer
|
|
3704 {not in Vi}
|
|
3705 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
|
|
3706 or |+eval| features}
|
|
3707 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
|
|
3708 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
|
|
3709 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
|
|
3710 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
|
|
3711 'smartindent' indenting.
|
|
3712 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
|
|
3713 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
|
534
|
3714 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line
|
7
|
3715 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
|
|
3716 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
|
|
3717 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
|
|
3718 used for the indent).
|
|
3719 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
|
|
3720 and |lispindent()|.
|
|
3721 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
|
|
3722 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
|
|
3723 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
|
|
3724 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
|
|
3725 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
|
|
3726 < Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
|
|
3727 "msg".
|
634
|
3728 See |indent-expression|.
|
7
|
3729 NOTE: This option is made empty when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
3730
|
634
|
3731 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
|
3732 |sandbox-option|.
|
|
3733
|
|
3734 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
|
3735 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
|
|
3736
|
|
3737
|
7
|
3738 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
|
|
3739 'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
|
|
3740 local to buffer
|
|
3741 {not in Vi}
|
|
3742 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
|
|
3743 feature}
|
|
3744 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
|
|
3745 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
|
|
3746 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
|
|
3747 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
|
|
3748
|
|
3749 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
|
|
3750 'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
|
|
3751 local to buffer
|
|
3752 {not in Vi}
|
|
3753 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
|
|
3754 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted. If the
|
|
3755 typed text contains a lowercase letter where the match has an upper
|
|
3756 case letter, the completed part is made lowercase. If the typed text
|
|
3757 has no lowercase letters and the match has a lowercase letter where
|
|
3758 the typed text has an uppercase letter, and there is a letter before
|
|
3759 it, the completed part is made uppercase.
|
|
3760
|
|
3761 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
|
|
3762 'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
|
|
3763 global
|
|
3764 {not in Vi}
|
|
3765 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
|
|
3766 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
|
|
3767 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
|
|
3768 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
|
|
3769 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|). When
|
|
3770 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
|
|
3771 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
|
|
3772 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
|
477
|
3773 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
|
|
3774 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
|
7
|
3775
|
|
3776 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
|
|
3777 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
|
|
3778 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
|
|
3779 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
|
|
3780 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
|
|
3781 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
|
|
3782 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
|
|
3783 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
|
|
3784 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
|
|
3785 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
|
|
3786
|
|
3787 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
3788
|
|
3789 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
|
|
3790 'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
|
|
3791 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
|
|
3792 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
|
|
3793 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
|
|
3794 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
|
|
3795 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
|
|
3796 global
|
|
3797 {not in Vi}
|
|
3798 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
|
|
3799 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
|
10
|
3800 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
|
7
|
3801 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
|
|
3802 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
|
|
3803 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
|
|
3804
|
|
3805 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
|
|
3806 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
|
|
3807 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
|
|
3808 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
|
|
3809 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
|
|
3810 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
|
|
3811 cmd.exe.
|
|
3812
|
|
3813 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
|
10
|
3814 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
|
|
3815 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
|
7
|
3816 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
|
|
3817 not work for digits). Example:
|
|
3818 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
|
|
3819 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
|
|
3820 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
|
|
3821 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
|
|
3822 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
|
|
3823 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
|
|
3824 option or the end of a range. Example:
|
|
3825 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
|
|
3826 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
|
|
3827 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
|
|
3828 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
|
|
3829 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
|
|
3830 case letters.
|
|
3831 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
|
|
3832 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
|
|
3833 expected. Example:
|
|
3834 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
|
|
3835 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
|
|
3836 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
|
|
3837 comma, plus <Tab>.
|
|
3838 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
|
|
3839
|
|
3840 *'isident'* *'isi'*
|
|
3841 'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
|
|
3842 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
|
|
3843 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
|
|
3844 global
|
|
3845 {not in Vi}
|
|
3846 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
|
|
3847 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
|
|
3848 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
|
233
|
3849 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
|
7
|
3850 option.
|
|
3851 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
|
10
|
3852 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
|
7
|
3853 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
|
|
3854
|
|
3855 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
|
|
3856 'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32:
|
|
3857 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
|
|
3858 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
|
|
3859 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
|
|
3860 local to buffer
|
|
3861 {not in Vi}
|
|
3862 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
|
10
|
3863 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
|
7
|
3864 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For C
|
|
3865 programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
|
|
3866 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
|
|
3867 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
|
|
3868 command).
|
|
3869 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
|
|
3870 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
3871 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
3872
|
|
3873 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
|
|
3874 'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh:
|
|
3875 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
|
|
3876 global
|
|
3877 {not in Vi}
|
|
3878 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
|
|
3879 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
|
|
3880 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
|
|
3881 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
|
|
3882 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
|
|
3883
|
|
3884 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
|
|
3885 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
|
|
3886 32 - 126 always single characters
|
|
3887 127 "^?"
|
|
3888 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
|
|
3889 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
|
|
3890 255 "~?"
|
|
3891 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
|
|
3892 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
|
|
3893 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
|
|
3894 displayed as <xx>.
|
|
3895 The NonText highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
|
|
3896 |hl-NonText|
|
|
3897
|
|
3898 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
|
|
3899 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
|
|
3900 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
|
|
3901 replacement character will be shown.
|
|
3902 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
|
|
3903 There is no option to specify these characters.
|
|
3904
|
|
3905 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
|
|
3906 'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
|
|
3907 global
|
|
3908 {not in Vi}
|
|
3909 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
|
|
3910 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
|
|
3911 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
|
|
3912 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
3913
|
|
3914 *'key'*
|
|
3915 'key' string (default "")
|
|
3916 local to buffer
|
|
3917 {not in Vi}
|
|
3918 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
|
|
3919 See |encryption|.
|
|
3920 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
|
|
3921 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
|
|
3922 :set key=
|
|
3923 < It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
|
|
3924 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
|
|
3925 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
|
|
3926 be careful not to make a typing error!
|
|
3927
|
|
3928 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
|
|
3929 'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
|
|
3930 local to buffer
|
|
3931 {not in Vi}
|
|
3932 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
|
|
3933 feature}
|
|
3934 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
|
|
3935 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
|
|
3936 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
|
|
3937 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
|
36
|
3938 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
|
7
|
3939
|
|
3940 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
|
|
3941 'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
|
|
3942 global
|
|
3943 {not in Vi}
|
|
3944 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys
|
|
3945 can do. These values can be used:
|
|
3946 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
|
|
3947 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
|
|
3948 present in 'selectmode').
|
|
3949 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
|
|
3950 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
|
|
3951 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
|
|
3952 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
|
|
3953
|
|
3954 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
|
|
3955 'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
|
|
3956 OS/2: "view /", VMS: "help")
|
|
3957 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
3958 {not in Vi}
|
|
3959 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
|
|
3960 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
|
|
3961 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
|
|
3962 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
|
|
3963 When "man" is used, Vim will automatically translate a count for the
|
|
3964 "K" command to a section number. Also for "man -s", in which case the
|
|
3965 "-s" is removed when there is no count.
|
|
3966 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
|
|
3967 Example: >
|
|
3968 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
|
|
3969 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
3970 security reasons.
|
|
3971
|
|
3972 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
|
|
3973 'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
|
|
3974 global
|
|
3975 {not in Vi}
|
|
3976 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
|
|
3977 feature}
|
|
3978 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
|
10
|
3979 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
|
7
|
3980 inserted directly. When in command mode the 'langmap' option takes
|
|
3981 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
|
|
3982 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
|
|
3983 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
|
|
3984 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
|
|
3985 mapped in Insert mode.
|
|
3986 This only works for 8-bit characters. The value of 'langmap' may be
|
|
3987 specified with multi-byte characters (e.g., UTF-8), but only the lower
|
|
3988 8 bits of each character will be used.
|
|
3989
|
|
3990 Example (for Greek): *greek* >
|
|
3991 :set langmap=ÁA,ÂB,ØC,ÄD,ÅE,ÖF,ÃG,ÇH,ÉI,ÎJ,ÊK,ËL,ÌM,ÍN,ÏO,ÐP,QQ,ÑR,ÓS,ÔT,ÈU,ÙV,WW,×X,ÕY,ÆZ,áa,âb,øc,äd,åe,öf,ãg,çh,éi,îj,êk,ël,ìm,ín,ïo,ðp,qq,ñr,ós,ôt,èu,ùv,òw,÷x,õy,æz
|
|
3992 < Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
|
|
3993 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
|
|
3994 <
|
|
3995 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
|
|
3996 part can be in one of two forms:
|
|
3997 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
|
|
3998 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
|
|
3999 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to"
|
|
4000 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
|
|
4001 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
|
|
4002 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
|
|
4003 ";", ',' and backslash itself.
|
|
4004
|
|
4005 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
|
|
4006 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
|
|
4007 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
|
|
4008 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
|
|
4009 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
|
|
4010 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
|
|
4011 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
|
|
4012 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
|
|
4013 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
|
|
4014 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
|
|
4015 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
|
|
4016
|
|
4017 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
|
|
4018 'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
|
|
4019 global
|
|
4020 {not in Vi}
|
|
4021 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
|
|
4022 |+multi_lang| features}
|
|
4023 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
|
|
4024 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
|
|
4025 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim"
|
|
4026 < (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
|
|
4027 matter what $LANG is set to: >
|
|
4028 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
|
|
4029 < When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
|
36
|
4030 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
|
7
|
4031 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
|
|
4032 the English menus: >
|
|
4033 :set langmenu=none
|
|
4034 < This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
|
|
4035 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
|
|
4036 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
|
|
4037 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
|
|
4038 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
|
|
4039 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
|
|
4040 < Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
|
|
4041
|
|
4042 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
|
|
4043 'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
|
|
4044 global
|
|
4045 {not in Vi}
|
|
4046 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
|
|
4047 status line:
|
|
4048 0: never
|
|
4049 1: only if there are at least two windows
|
|
4050 2: always
|
|
4051 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
|
|
4052 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
|
|
4053
|
|
4054 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
|
|
4055 'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
|
|
4056 global
|
|
4057 {not in Vi}
|
|
4058 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
|
|
4059 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
|
10
|
4060 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
|
7
|
4061 update use |:redraw|.
|
|
4062
|
|
4063 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
|
|
4064 'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
|
|
4065 local to window
|
|
4066 {not in Vi}
|
|
4067 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
|
|
4068 feature}
|
|
4069 If on Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
|
|
4070 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
|
|
4071 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
|
|
4072 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents. The
|
|
4073 value of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines.
|
|
4074 This option is not used when the 'wrap' option is off or 'list' is on.
|
|
4075 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
|
|
4076 with the right amount of white space.
|
|
4077
|
|
4078 *'lines'* *E593*
|
|
4079 'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
|
|
4080 global
|
|
4081 Number of lines of the Vim window.
|
|
4082 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
|
161
|
4083 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
|
7
|
4084 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
|
|
4085 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
|
|
4086 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
|
|
4087 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
|
|
4088 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
|
|
4089 :set lines=999
|
571
|
4090 < Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000.
|
|
4091 If you get less lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
|
7
|
4092 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
|
|
4093 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
|
|
4094
|
|
4095 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
|
|
4096 'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
|
|
4097 global
|
|
4098 {not in Vi}
|
|
4099 {only in the GUI}
|
|
4100 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
|
|
4101 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
|
|
4102 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
|
180
|
4103 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
|
|
4104 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
|
|
4105 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
|
|
4106 though!
|
7
|
4107
|
|
4108 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
|
|
4109 'lisp' boolean (default off)
|
|
4110 local to buffer
|
|
4111 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
|
|
4112 feature}
|
|
4113 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
|
|
4114 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
|
|
4115 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
|
|
4116 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
|
|
4117 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
|
|
4118 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
|
|
4119 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
|
|
4120 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
|
|
4121 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
|
|
4122 {Vi: Does it a little bit differently}
|
|
4123
|
|
4124 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
|
|
4125 'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
|
|
4126 global
|
|
4127 {not in Vi}
|
|
4128 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
|
|
4129 feature}
|
|
4130 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting.
|
|
4131 |'lisp'|
|
|
4132
|
|
4133 *'list'* *'nolist'*
|
|
4134 'list' boolean (default off)
|
|
4135 local to window
|
|
4136 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I, show end of line with $. Useful to
|
|
4137 see the difference between tabs and spaces and for trailing blanks.
|
|
4138 Note that this will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth' or
|
|
4139 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
|
|
4140 changing the way tabs are displayed.
|
|
4141
|
|
4142 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
|
|
4143 'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
|
|
4144 global
|
|
4145 {not in Vi}
|
10
|
4146 Strings to use in 'list' mode. It is a comma separated list of string
|
7
|
4147 settings.
|
|
4148 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
|
|
4149 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
|
|
4150 line.
|
|
4151 tab:xy Two characters to be used to show a Tab. The first
|
|
4152 char is used once. The second char is repeated to
|
|
4153 fill the space that the Tab normally occupies.
|
|
4154 "tab:>-" will show a Tab that takes four spaces as
|
|
4155 ">---". When omitted, a Tab is show as ^I.
|
10
|
4156 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
|
7
|
4157 trailing spaces are blank.
|
|
4158 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
|
|
4159 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
|
|
4160 screen.
|
|
4161 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap'
|
|
4162 is off and there is text preceding the character
|
|
4163 visible in the first column.
|
13
|
4164 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space (character
|
|
4165 0xA0, 160). Left blank when omitted.
|
7
|
4166
|
10
|
4167 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
|
7
|
4168 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
|
|
4169 characters are allowed.
|
|
4170
|
|
4171 Examples: >
|
|
4172 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
|
12
|
4173 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
|
7
|
4174 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
|
|
4175 < The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
|
12
|
4176 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "tab" and "trail".
|
7
|
4177
|
|
4178 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
|
|
4179 'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
|
|
4180 global
|
|
4181 {not in Vi}
|
|
4182 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
|
|
4183 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
|
|
4184 of plugins.
|
|
4185 Note that using the "-u NONE" and "--noplugin" command line arguments
|
|
4186 reset this option. |-u| |--noplugin|
|
|
4187
|
|
4188 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
|
|
4189 'magic' boolean (default on)
|
|
4190 global
|
|
4191 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
|
|
4192 See |pattern|.
|
|
4193 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with using patterns, always keep
|
|
4194 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
|
|
4195 old Vi scripts. In any other situation write patterns that work when
|
20
|
4196 'magic' is on. Include "\M" when you want to |/\M|.
|
7
|
4197
|
|
4198 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
|
|
4199 'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
|
|
4200 global
|
|
4201 {not in Vi}
|
|
4202 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
|
|
4203 feature}
|
|
4204 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
|
|
4205 and the |:grep| command.
|
|
4206 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
|
|
4207 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
|
|
4208 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
|
|
4209 existing file.
|
|
4210 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
|
|
4211 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
|
|
4212 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
|
|
4213 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
4214 security reasons.
|
|
4215
|
|
4216 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
|
|
4217 'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
|
|
4218 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
4219 {not in Vi}
|
|
4220 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|. This
|
|
4221 option may contain '%' and '#' characters, which are expanded like
|
|
4222 when used in a command-line. Environment variables are expanded
|
|
4223 |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces and
|
|
4224 backslashes. Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set"
|
|
4225 and once for the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter
|
|
4226 called "myfilter" do it like this: >
|
|
4227 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
|
|
4228 < The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
|
|
4229 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
|
|
4230 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
|
|
4231 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
4232 security reasons.
|
|
4233
|
|
4234 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
|
|
4235 'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
|
|
4236 local to buffer
|
|
4237 {not in Vi}
|
|
4238 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
|
10
|
4239 other. Currently only single character pairs are allowed, and they
|
7
|
4240 must be different. The characters must be separated by a colon. The
|
|
4241 pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and '>'
|
|
4242 (HTML): >
|
|
4243 :set mps+=<:>
|
|
4244
|
|
4245 < A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
|
|
4246 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
|
|
4247 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
|
|
4248
|
|
4249 < For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
|
|
4250 the $VIMRUNTIME/macros directory. |add-local-help|
|
|
4251
|
|
4252 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
|
|
4253 'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
|
|
4254 global
|
|
4255 {not in Vi}{in Nvi}
|
|
4256 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
|
|
4257 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
|
|
4258 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
|
|
4259
|
|
4260 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
|
|
4261 'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
|
|
4262 global
|
|
4263 {not in Vi}
|
|
4264 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
|
|
4265 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
|
|
4266 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
|
|
4267 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
|
|
4268 See also |:function|.
|
|
4269
|
|
4270 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
|
|
4271 'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
|
|
4272 global
|
|
4273 {not in Vi}
|
|
4274 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
|
|
4275 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
|
|
4276 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
|
|
4277 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
|
|
4278 |key-mapping|.
|
|
4279
|
|
4280 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
|
|
4281 'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
|
|
4282 dependent) or half the amount of memory
|
|
4283 available)
|
|
4284 global
|
|
4285 {not in Vi}
|
|
4286 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
|
|
4287 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
|
|
4288 other memory to be freed. Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work
|
|
4289 without a limit. Also see 'maxmemtot'.
|
|
4290
|
189
|
4291 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
|
|
4292 'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
|
|
4293 global
|
|
4294 {not in Vi}
|
|
4295 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
|
|
4296 Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
|
|
4297 *E363*
|
|
4298 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message mostly behaves
|
|
4299 like CTRL-C was typed.
|
|
4300 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
|
|
4301 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
|
|
4302 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
|
|
4303 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit.
|
|
4304
|
7
|
4305 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
|
|
4306 'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
|
|
4307 dependent) or half the amount of memory
|
|
4308 available)
|
|
4309 global
|
|
4310 {not in Vi}
|
|
4311 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for all buffers together.
|
10
|
4312 Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work without a limit. Also see
|
7
|
4313 'maxmem'.
|
|
4314
|
|
4315 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
|
|
4316 'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
|
|
4317 global
|
|
4318 {not in Vi}
|
|
4319 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
|
|
4320 feature}
|
|
4321 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
|
|
4322 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
|
|
4323 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
|
|
4324
|
484
|
4325 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
|
|
4326 'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
|
|
4327 global
|
|
4328 {not in Vi}
|
|
4329 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
|
|
4330 feature}
|
|
4331 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
|
|
4332 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
|
|
4333 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
|
|
4334 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
|
|
4335 this tuning is complicated.
|
|
4336
|
|
4337 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
|
|
4338 {start},{inc},{added}
|
|
4339
|
|
4340 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
|
|
4341 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
|
|
4342 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
|
|
4343 memory that is available to Vim.
|
|
4344
|
|
4345 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
|
|
4346 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
|
|
4347 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
|
|
4348 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
|
|
4349 will be allocated.
|
|
4350
|
|
4351 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
|
|
4352 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
|
|
4353 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
|
|
4354 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
|
|
4355 slower.
|
|
4356
|
|
4357 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
|
|
4358 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
|
|
4359 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
|
|
4360 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
|
|
4361 < If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
|
|
4362 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
|
|
4363
|
7
|
4364 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
|
|
4365 'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
|
|
4366 local to buffer
|
|
4367 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
|
|
4368 'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
|
|
4369 global
|
|
4370 {not in Vi}
|
|
4371 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
|
|
4372 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
|
|
4373 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
|
|
4374 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
4375 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
4376
|
|
4377 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
|
|
4378 'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
|
|
4379 local to buffer
|
|
4380 {not in Vi} *E21*
|
|
4381 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
|
|
4382 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
|
|
4383 Can be reset with the |-M| command line argument.
|
|
4384
|
|
4385 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
|
|
4386 'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
|
|
4387 local to buffer
|
|
4388 {not in Vi}
|
|
4389 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
|
|
4390 when:
|
|
4391 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
|
|
4392 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
|
|
4393 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
|
|
4394 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
|
|
4395 when it was written.
|
|
4396 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
|
|
4397 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
|
|
4398 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
|
|
4399 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
|
|
4400 reset.
|
|
4401 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
|
|
4402 will be ignored.
|
|
4403
|
|
4404 *'more'* *'nomore'*
|
|
4405 'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
|
|
4406 global
|
|
4407 {not in Vi}
|
|
4408 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
|
|
4409 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
|
|
4410 listing continues until finished.
|
|
4411 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
4412 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
4413
|
|
4414 *'mouse'* *E538*
|
|
4415 'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32)
|
|
4416 global
|
|
4417 {not in Vi}
|
|
4418 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals
|
|
4419 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, and Linux console
|
|
4420 with gpm). For using the mouse in the GUI, see |gui-mouse|.
|
|
4421 The mouse can be enabled for different modes:
|
|
4422 n Normal mode
|
|
4423 v Visual mode
|
|
4424 i Insert mode
|
|
4425 c Command-line mode
|
|
4426 h all previous modes when editing a help file
|
|
4427 a all previous modes
|
|
4428 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
|
|
4429 Normally you would enable the mouse in all four modes with: >
|
|
4430 :set mouse=a
|
|
4431 < When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
|
|
4432 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
|
|
4433
|
|
4434 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
|
|
4435
|
|
4436 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
|
10
|
4437 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
|
7
|
4438 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
|
|
4439 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
|
|
4440
|
|
4441 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
|
|
4442 'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
|
|
4443 global
|
|
4444 {not in Vi}
|
|
4445 {only works in the GUI}
|
|
4446 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
|
|
4447 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
|
|
4448 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
|
|
4449 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
|
|
4450 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
|
|
4451
|
|
4452 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
|
|
4453 'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
|
|
4454 global
|
|
4455 {not in Vi}
|
|
4456 {only works in the GUI}
|
|
4457 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
|
|
4458 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
|
|
4459
|
|
4460 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
|
|
4461 'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32)
|
|
4462 global
|
|
4463 {not in Vi}
|
|
4464 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
|
|
4465 the right mouse button is used for:
|
|
4466 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
|
|
4467 like in an xterm.
|
|
4468 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
|
|
4469 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
|
233
|
4470 with Microsoft Windows.
|
7
|
4471 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
|
|
4472 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
|
|
4473 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
|
|
4474 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
|
233
|
4475 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
|
7
|
4476 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
|
|
4477 end Visual mode.
|
|
4478 Overview of what button does what for each model:
|
|
4479 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
|
|
4480 left click place cursor place cursor
|
|
4481 left drag start selection start selection
|
|
4482 shift-left search word extend selection
|
|
4483 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
|
|
4484 right drag extend selection -
|
|
4485 middle click paste paste
|
|
4486
|
|
4487 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
|
|
4488 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
|
|
4489
|
|
4490 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
|
|
4491 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
|
|
4492 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
|
|
4493
|
|
4494 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
|
|
4495
|
|
4496 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
|
|
4497 'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i:beam,r:beam,s:updown,sd:cross,
|
233
|
4498 m:no,ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
|
7
|
4499 global
|
|
4500 {not in Vi}
|
|
4501 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
|
|
4502 feature}
|
|
4503 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
|
|
4504 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much
|
|
4505 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list
|
|
4506 and an argument-list:
|
|
4507 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
|
|
4508 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
|
|
4509 In a normal window: ~
|
|
4510 n Normal mode
|
|
4511 v Visual mode
|
|
4512 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
|
|
4513 if not specified)
|
|
4514 o Operator-pending mode
|
|
4515 i Insert mode
|
|
4516 r Replace mode
|
|
4517
|
|
4518 Others: ~
|
|
4519 c appending to the command-line
|
|
4520 ci inserting in the command-line
|
|
4521 cr replacing in the command-line
|
|
4522 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
|
|
4523 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
|
|
4524 e any mode, pointer below last window
|
|
4525 s any mode, pointer on a status line
|
|
4526 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
|
|
4527 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
|
|
4528 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
|
|
4529 a everywhere
|
|
4530
|
|
4531 The shape is one of the following:
|
|
4532 avail name looks like ~
|
|
4533 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer
|
|
4534 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
|
|
4535 w x beam I-beam
|
|
4536 w x updown up-down sizing arrows
|
|
4537 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows
|
|
4538 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer
|
|
4539 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
|
|
4540 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing
|
|
4541 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
|
|
4542 x crosshair like a big thin +
|
|
4543 x hand1 black hand
|
|
4544 x hand2 white hand
|
|
4545 x pencil what you write with
|
|
4546 x question big ?
|
|
4547 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
|
|
4548 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
|
|
4549 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
|
|
4550
|
|
4551 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
|
|
4552 x for X11.
|
|
4553 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
|
|
4554 pointer.
|
|
4555
|
|
4556 Example: >
|
|
4557 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
|
|
4558 < will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
|
|
4559 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
|
|
4560 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
|
|
4561
|
|
4562 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
|
|
4563 'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
|
|
4564 global
|
|
4565 {not in Vi}
|
|
4566 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
|
|
4567 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
|
|
4568 recognized as a multi click.
|
|
4569
|
14
|
4570 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
|
|
4571 'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
|
|
4572 global
|
|
4573 {not in Vi}
|
|
4574 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
|
|
4575 feature}
|
|
4576 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
|
|
4577 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
|
|
4578
|
7
|
4579 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
|
|
4580 'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "octal,hex")
|
|
4581 local to buffer
|
|
4582 {not in Vi}
|
|
4583 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
|
|
4584 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
|
|
4585 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
|
625
|
4586 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be
|
7
|
4587 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
|
|
4588 letter index a), b), etc.
|
625
|
4589 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
|
7
|
4590 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
|
625
|
4591 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
|
7
|
4592 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
|
|
4593 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
|
|
4594 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
|
|
4595 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
|
|
4596 recognized as octal or hex.
|
|
4597
|
|
4598 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
|
|
4599 'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
|
|
4600 local to window
|
|
4601 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
|
|
4602 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
|
|
4603 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
|
13
|
4604 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
|
|
4605 number.
|
7
|
4606 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
|
|
4607 characters are put before the number.
|
|
4608 See |hl-LineNr| for the highlighting used for the number.
|
|
4609
|
13
|
4610 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
|
|
4611 'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
|
|
4612 local to window
|
14
|
4613 {not in Vi}
|
|
4614 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
|
|
4615 feature}
|
13
|
4616 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
|
677
|
4617 when the 'number' option is set or printint lines with a line number.
|
13
|
4618 Since one space is always between the number and the text, there is
|
|
4619 one less character for the number itself.
|
|
4620 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
|
|
4621 fit the highest line number in the buffer. Thus with the Vim default
|
|
4622 of 4 there is room for a line number up to 999. When the buffer has
|
|
4623 1000 lines five columns will be used.
|
|
4624 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 10.
|
|
4625 NOTE: 'numberwidth' is reset to 8 when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
4626
|
523
|
4627 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'*
|
|
4628 'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
|
502
|
4629 local to buffer
|
|
4630 {not in Vi}
|
|
4631 {not available when compiled without the +eval
|
|
4632 or +insert_expand feature}
|
623
|
4633 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni
|
|
4634 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
|
648
|
4635 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
|
|
4636 invoked and what it should return.
|
502
|
4637
|
|
4638
|
593
|
4639 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'*
|
|
4640 'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty)
|
|
4641 global
|
|
4642 {not in Vi}
|
|
4643 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator.
|
|
4644 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example.
|
|
4645
|
|
4646 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
4647 security reasons.
|
|
4648
|
|
4649
|
7
|
4650 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'* *E366*
|
|
4651 'osfiletype' 'oft' string (RISC-OS default: "Text",
|
|
4652 others default: "")
|
|
4653 local to buffer
|
|
4654 {not in Vi}
|
|
4655 {only available when compiled with the |+osfiletype|
|
|
4656 feature}
|
|
4657 Some operating systems store extra information about files besides
|
|
4658 name, datestamp and permissions. This option contains the extra
|
|
4659 information, the nature of which will vary between systems.
|
|
4660 The value of this option is usually set when the file is loaded, and
|
|
4661 use to set the file type when file is written.
|
|
4662 It can affect the pattern matching of the automatic commands.
|
|
4663 |autocmd-osfiletypes|
|
|
4664
|
|
4665 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
|
|
4666 'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP LIpplpipbp")
|
|
4667 global
|
|
4668 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
|
|
4669 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
|
|
4670
|
|
4671 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
|
|
4672 'paste' boolean (default off)
|
|
4673 global
|
|
4674 {not in Vi}
|
10
|
4675 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
|
|
4676 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
|
7
|
4677 unexpected effects.
|
|
4678 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
|
10
|
4679 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
|
7
|
4680 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
|
|
4681 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
|
|
4682 mouse clicks itself.
|
148
|
4683 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
|
|
4684 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
|
|
4685 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
|
|
4686 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
|
7
|
4687 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
|
|
4688 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
|
|
4689 - abbreviations are disabled
|
|
4690 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
|
|
4691 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
|
|
4692 - 'autoindent' is reset
|
|
4693 - 'smartindent' is reset
|
|
4694 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
|
|
4695 - 'revins' is reset
|
|
4696 - 'ruler' is reset
|
|
4697 - 'showmatch' is reset
|
|
4698 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
|
|
4699 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
|
|
4700 - 'lisp'
|
|
4701 - 'indentexpr'
|
|
4702 - 'cindent'
|
|
4703 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
|
|
4704 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
|
|
4705 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
|
|
4706 set the 'paste' option again.
|
|
4707 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
|
|
4708 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
|
|
4709 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
|
|
4710 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
|
|
4711 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
|
|
4712
|
|
4713 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
|
|
4714 'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
|
|
4715 global
|
|
4716 {not in Vi}
|
|
4717 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
|
|
4718 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
|
|
4719 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
|
|
4720 < Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
|
|
4721 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
|
|
4722 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
|
|
4723 Command-line mode.
|
|
4724 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
|
|
4725 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
|
|
4726 this: >
|
|
4727 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
|
|
4728 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
|
|
4729 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
|
|
4730 :imap <F11> <nop>
|
|
4731 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
|
|
4732 < This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
|
|
4733 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
|
|
4734 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
|
|
4735 sequence.
|
|
4736
|
|
4737 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
|
|
4738 'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
|
|
4739 global
|
|
4740 {not in Vi}
|
|
4741 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
|
|
4742 feature}
|
|
4743 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
|
10
|
4744 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
|
7
|
4745
|
|
4746 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E206*
|
|
4747 'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
|
|
4748 global
|
|
4749 {not in Vi}
|
|
4750 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
|
|
4751 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
|
|
4752 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
|
|
4753 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
|
|
4754 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
|
|
4755 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
|
|
4756 ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work (Detail: The
|
|
4757 backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the new file has
|
|
4758 been successfully written, that's why it must be possible to write a
|
|
4759 backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an empty file is
|
|
4760 created.
|
|
4761 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
|
|
4762 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
|
|
4763 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
|
|
4764 recognized as a compressed file.
|
36
|
4765 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
|
7
|
4766
|
|
4767 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347*
|
|
4768 'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
|
|
4769 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,,"
|
|
4770 other systems: ".,,")
|
|
4771 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
4772 {not in Vi}
|
|
4773 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
|
|
4774 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find| and other commands, provided that the file
|
|
4775 being searched for has a relative path (not starting with '/'). The
|
|
4776 directories in the 'path' option may be relative or absolute.
|
|
4777 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
|
|
4778 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
|
|
4779 < - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
|
|
4780 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
|
|
4781 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
|
|
4782 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
|
|
4783 < - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
|
|
4784 backslash: >
|
|
4785 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
|
|
4786 < - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
|
|
4787 :set path=.
|
|
4788 < - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
|
|
4789 commas: >
|
|
4790 :set path=,,
|
|
4791 < - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
|
|
4792 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
|
|
4793 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
|
|
4794 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
|
|
4795 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree:
|
|
4796 1) "*" matches a sequence of characters, e.g.: >
|
|
4797 :set path=/usr/include/*
|
|
4798 < means all subdirectories in /usr/include (but not /usr/include
|
|
4799 itself). >
|
|
4800 :set path=/usr/*c
|
|
4801 < matches /usr/doc and /usr/src.
|
|
4802 2) "**" matches a subtree, up to 100 directories deep. Example: >
|
|
4803 :set path=/home/user_x/src/**
|
|
4804 < means search in the whole subtree under "/home/usr_x/src".
|
|
4805 3) If the path ends with a ';', this path is the startpoint
|
|
4806 for upward search.
|
|
4807 See |file-searching| for more info and exact syntax.
|
|
4808 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature}
|
|
4809 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
|
|
4810 :set path=.,c:\\include
|
|
4811 < Or just use '/' instead: >
|
|
4812 :set path=.,c:/include
|
|
4813 < Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
|
|
4814 the file!
|
10
|
4815 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
|
7
|
4816 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
|
|
4817 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
|
|
4818 'path', see |:checkpath|.
|
|
4819 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
|
|
4820 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
|
|
4821 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
|
|
4822 :set path-=
|
|
4823 < To add the current directory use: >
|
|
4824 :set path+=
|
|
4825 < To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
|
|
4826 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
|
|
4827 names are separated with a semi-colon: >
|
|
4828 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
|
|
4829 < Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
|
|
4830 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
|
|
4831
|
|
4832 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
|
|
4833 'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
|
|
4834 local to buffer
|
|
4835 {not in Vi}
|
|
4836 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
|
|
4837 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
|
|
4838 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
|
|
4839 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
|
|
4840 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
|
|
4841 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
|
|
4842 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
|
|
4843 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
|
|
4844 NOTE: 'preserveindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
4845 Also see 'copyindent'.
|
|
4846 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
|
|
4847
|
|
4848 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
|
|
4849 'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
|
|
4850 global
|
|
4851 {not in Vi}
|
|
4852 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
|
|
4853 |+quickfix| feature}
|
|
4854 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
|
|
4855 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given.
|
|
4856
|
|
4857 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
|
|
4858 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
|
|
4859 'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
|
|
4860 local to window
|
|
4861 {not in Vi}
|
|
4862 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
|
|
4863 |+quickfix| feature}
|
10
|
4864 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
|
7
|
4865 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
|
|
4866 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
|
|
4867
|
|
4868 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
|
|
4869 'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
|
|
4870 global
|
|
4871 {not in Vi}
|
|
4872 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
|
|
4873 feature}
|
15
|
4874 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
|
|
4875 See |pdev-option|.
|
36
|
4876 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
4877 security reasons.
|
15
|
4878
|
|
4879 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
|
|
4880 'printencoding' 'penc' String (default empty, except for some systems)
|
7
|
4881 global
|
|
4882 {not in Vi}
|
|
4883 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
|
|
4884 and |+postscript| features}
|
15
|
4885 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
|
|
4886 See |penc-option|.
|
7
|
4887
|
|
4888 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
|
|
4889 'printexpr' 'pexpr' String (default: see below)
|
|
4890 global
|
|
4891 {not in Vi}
|
|
4892 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
|
|
4893 and |+postscript| features}
|
15
|
4894 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
|
|
4895 See |pexpr-option|.
|
|
4896
|
|
4897 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
|
7
|
4898 'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
|
|
4899 global
|
|
4900 {not in Vi}
|
|
4901 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
|
|
4902 feature}
|
15
|
4903 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
|
|
4904 See |pfn-option|.
|
7
|
4905
|
|
4906 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
|
|
4907 'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
|
|
4908 global
|
|
4909 {not in Vi}
|
|
4910 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
|
|
4911 feature}
|
15
|
4912 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
|
|
4913 See |pheader-option|.
|
|
4914
|
|
4915 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
|
|
4916 'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
|
|
4917 global
|
|
4918 {not in Vi}
|
180
|
4919 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
|
|
4920 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
|
15
|
4921 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
|
|
4922 See |pmbcs-option|.
|
|
4923
|
|
4924 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
|
|
4925 'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
|
|
4926 global
|
|
4927 {not in Vi}
|
180
|
4928 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
|
|
4929 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
|
15
|
4930 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
|
|
4931 See |pmbfn-option|.
|
7
|
4932
|
|
4933 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
|
|
4934 'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
|
|
4935 global
|
|
4936 {not in Vi}
|
|
4937 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
|
15
|
4938 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
|
|
4939 See |popt-option|.
|
|
4940
|
168
|
4941 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
|
|
4942 'prompt' boolean (default on)
|
|
4943 global
|
|
4944 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
|
|
4945
|
140
|
4946 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
|
12
|
4947 'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
|
|
4948 local to buffer
|
|
4949 {not in Vi}
|
|
4950 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
|
|
4951 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
|
|
4952 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
|
|
4953 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
|
|
4954 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
|
|
4955
|
7
|
4956 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
|
|
4957 'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
|
|
4958 local to buffer
|
|
4959 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
|
|
4960 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
|
|
4961 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
|
164
|
4962 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
|
|
4963 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
|
7
|
4964 {not in Vi:} When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is
|
164
|
4965 set for the newly edited buffer.
|
7
|
4966
|
|
4967 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
|
|
4968 'remap' boolean (default on)
|
|
4969 global
|
|
4970 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
|
|
4971 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
|
|
4972
|
|
4973 *'report'*
|
|
4974 'report' number (default 2)
|
|
4975 global
|
|
4976 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
|
|
4977 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
|
|
4978 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
|
|
4979 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
|
|
4980 instead of the number of lines.
|
|
4981
|
|
4982 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
|
|
4983 'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
|
|
4984 global
|
|
4985 {not in Vi} {only in Windows 95/NT console version}
|
|
4986 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
|
|
4987 happens when executing external commands.
|
|
4988
|
|
4989 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
|
|
4990 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
|
|
4991 set t_ti= t_te=
|
|
4992 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
|
|
4993 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
|
|
4994 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
|
|
4995
|
|
4996 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
|
|
4997 'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
|
|
4998 global
|
|
4999 {not in Vi}
|
|
5000 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
|
|
5001 feature}
|
|
5002 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
|
|
5003 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
|
|
5004 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
|
|
5005 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' or 'paste' is set.
|
|
5006
|
|
5007 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
|
|
5008 'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
|
|
5009 local to window
|
|
5010 {not in Vi}
|
|
5011 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
|
|
5012 feature}
|
|
5013 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
|
|
5014 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
|
|
5015 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
|
|
5016 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
|
|
5017 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
|
|
5018 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
|
|
5019 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
|
|
5020 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
|
|
5021 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
|
|
5022
|
|
5023 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'* *'norightleftcmd'* *'norlc'*
|
|
5024 'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
|
|
5025 local to window
|
|
5026 {not in Vi}
|
|
5027 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
|
|
5028 feature}
|
|
5029 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
|
|
5030 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
|
|
5031
|
|
5032 search "/" and "?" commands
|
|
5033
|
|
5034 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
|
|
5035 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
|
|
5036
|
|
5037 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
|
|
5038 'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off)
|
|
5039 global
|
|
5040 {not in Vi}
|
|
5041 {not available when compiled without the
|
|
5042 |+cmdline_info| feature}
|
|
5043 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
|
10
|
5044 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
|
7
|
5045 text in the file is shown on the far right:
|
|
5046 Top first line is visible
|
|
5047 Bot last line is visible
|
|
5048 All first and last line are visible
|
|
5049 45% relative position in the file
|
|
5050 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
|
10
|
5051 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
|
7
|
5052 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
|
233
|
5053 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
|
7
|
5054 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'
|
|
5055 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
|
|
5056 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both
|
|
5057 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
|
|
5058 separated with a dash.
|
|
5059 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
|
|
5060 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
|
|
5061 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
|
|
5062 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
|
|
5063 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
|
|
5064 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
5065
|
|
5066 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
|
|
5067 'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
|
|
5068 global
|
|
5069 {not in Vi}
|
|
5070 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
|
|
5071 feature}
|
|
5072 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
|
|
5073 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
|
|
5074 The format of this option, is like that of 'statusline'.
|
|
5075 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
|
|
5076 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
|
|
5077 Example: >
|
|
5078 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
|
|
5079 <
|
|
5080 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
|
|
5081 'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
|
|
5082 Unix: "$HOME/.vim,
|
|
5083 $VIM/vimfiles,
|
|
5084 $VIMRUNTIME,
|
|
5085 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
|
|
5086 $HOME/.vim/after"
|
|
5087 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
|
|
5088 $VIM/vimfiles,
|
|
5089 $VIMRUNTIME,
|
|
5090 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
|
|
5091 home:vimfiles/after"
|
|
5092 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles,
|
|
5093 $VIM/vimfiles,
|
|
5094 $VIMRUNTIME,
|
|
5095 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
|
|
5096 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
|
|
5097 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles,
|
|
5098 $VIMRUNTIME,
|
|
5099 $VIM:vimfiles:after"
|
|
5100 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles,
|
|
5101 $VIMRUNTIME,
|
|
5102 Choices:vimfiles/after"
|
|
5103 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
|
|
5104 $VIM/vimfiles,
|
|
5105 $VIMRUNTIME,
|
|
5106 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
|
233
|
5107 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
|
7
|
5108 global
|
|
5109 {not in Vi}
|
|
5110 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
|
|
5111 files:
|
|
5112 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
|
|
5113 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
|
164
|
5114 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
|
7
|
5115 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
|
|
5116 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
|
|
5117 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
|
|
5118 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
|
|
5119 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
|
|
5120 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
|
|
5121 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans|
|
|
5122 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
|
|
5123 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
|
|
5124 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
|
650
|
5125 spell/ spell checking files |spell|
|
7
|
5126 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
|
|
5127 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
|
|
5128
|
|
5129 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
|
|
5130
|
|
5131 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
|
|
5132 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
|
|
5133 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
|
|
5134 administrator.
|
|
5135 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
|
|
5136 *after-directory*
|
|
5137 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
|
|
5138 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
|
|
5139 defaults (rarely needed)
|
|
5140 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
|
|
5141 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
|
|
5142 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
|
|
5143
|
|
5144 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
|
|
5145 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
|
10
|
5146 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
|
7
|
5147 wildcards.
|
|
5148 See |:runtime|.
|
|
5149 Example: >
|
|
5150 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
|
|
5151 < This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
|
|
5152 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
|
|
5153 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
|
|
5154 files).
|
|
5155 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
|
|
5156 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
|
|
5157 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
|
|
5158 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
|
|
5159 runtime files.
|
|
5160 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
5161 security reasons.
|
|
5162
|
|
5163 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
|
|
5164 'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
|
|
5165 local to window
|
|
5166 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
|
|
5167 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
|
|
5168 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
|
10
|
5169 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
|
7
|
5170 height with ":set scroll=0". {Vi is a bit different: 'scroll' gives
|
|
5171 the number of screen lines instead of file lines, makes a difference
|
|
5172 when lines wrap}
|
|
5173
|
|
5174 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
|
|
5175 'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
|
|
5176 local to window
|
|
5177 {not in Vi}
|
|
5178 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
|
|
5179 feature}
|
|
5180 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current
|
|
5181 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have
|
|
5182 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the
|
|
5183 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
|
|
5184 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
|
|
5185 interpreted.
|
|
5186 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
|
|
5187 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
|
|
5188 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
|
|
5189
|
|
5190 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
|
|
5191 'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
|
|
5192 global
|
|
5193 {not in Vi}
|
|
5194 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
|
|
5195 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
|
|
5196 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
|
532
|
5197 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the
|
|
5198 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window
|
|
5199 height.
|
7
|
5200 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
5201
|
|
5202 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
|
|
5203 'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0)
|
|
5204 global
|
|
5205 {not in Vi}
|
|
5206 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
|
|
5207 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
|
|
5208 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
|
|
5209 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
|
|
5210 when long lines wrap).
|
|
5211 For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
|
|
5212 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
5213
|
|
5214 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
|
|
5215 'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
|
|
5216 global
|
|
5217 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
|
|
5218 feature}
|
|
5219 {not in Vi}
|
|
5220 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
|
236
|
5221 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
|
|
5222 Options.
|
7
|
5223 The following words are available:
|
|
5224 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
|
|
5225 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
|
|
5226 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
|
|
5227 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
|
|
5228 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
|
|
5229 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
|
|
5230 reach a position before the start or after the end of
|
|
5231 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
|
|
5232 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
|
|
5233 to the desired position when possible.
|
|
5234 When now making that window the current one, two
|
|
5235 things can be done with the relative offset:
|
|
5236 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
|
|
5237 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
|
|
5238 window. When going back to the other window, the
|
|
5239 the new relative offset will be used.
|
|
5240 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
|
|
5241 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
|
|
5242 going back to the other window, it still uses the
|
|
5243 same relative offset.
|
|
5244 Also see |scroll-binding|.
|
|
5245
|
|
5246 *'sections'* *'sect'*
|
|
5247 'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
|
|
5248 global
|
|
5249 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
|
|
5250 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
|
|
5251 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
|
|
5252
|
|
5253 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
|
|
5254 'secure' boolean (default off)
|
|
5255 global
|
|
5256 {not in Vi}
|
|
5257 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
|
|
5258 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
|
|
5259 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
|
|
5260 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
|
|
5261 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
|
10
|
5262 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
|
7
|
5263 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
|
|
5264 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
5265 security reasons.
|
|
5266
|
|
5267 *'selection'* *'sel'*
|
|
5268 'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
|
|
5269 global
|
|
5270 {not in Vi}
|
|
5271 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
|
|
5272 in Visual and Select mode.
|
|
5273 Possible values:
|
|
5274 value past line inclusive ~
|
|
5275 old no yes
|
|
5276 inclusive yes yes
|
|
5277 exclusive yes no
|
|
5278 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
|
|
5279 character past the line.
|
|
5280 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
|
|
5281 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
|
|
5282 selection.
|
|
5283 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
|
|
5284 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
|
|
5285 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
|
|
5286
|
|
5287 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
|
|
5288
|
|
5289 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
|
|
5290 'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
|
|
5291 global
|
|
5292 {not in Vi}
|
|
5293 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start
|
|
5294 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
|
|
5295 Possible values:
|
|
5296 mouse when using the mouse
|
|
5297 key when using shifted special keys
|
|
5298 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
|
|
5299 See |Select-mode|.
|
|
5300 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
|
|
5301
|
|
5302 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
|
|
5303 'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
|
|
5304 help,options,winsize")
|
|
5305 global
|
|
5306 {not in Vi}
|
|
5307 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
|
|
5308 feature}
|
|
5309 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
|
|
5310 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
|
|
5311 something:
|
|
5312 word save and restore ~
|
|
5313 blank empty windows
|
|
5314 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
|
|
5315 curdir the current directory
|
|
5316 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
|
|
5317 fold options
|
|
5318 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
|
75
|
5319 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
|
|
5320 String and Number types are stored.
|
7
|
5321 help the help window
|
|
5322 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
|
|
5323 global values for local options)
|
|
5324 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
|
|
5325 options)
|
|
5326 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
|
|
5327 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
|
|
5328 will become the current directory (useful with
|
|
5329 projects accessed over a network from different
|
|
5330 systems)
|
|
5331 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
|
|
5332 slashes
|
|
5333 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
|
|
5334 on Windows or DOS
|
|
5335 winpos position of the whole Vim window
|
|
5336 winsize window sizes
|
|
5337
|
|
5338 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
|
674
|
5339 There is no option to include tab pages yet, only the current tab page
|
|
5340 is stored in the session. |tab-page|
|
7
|
5341 When "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored with
|
|
5342 absolute paths.
|
|
5343 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
|
|
5344 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
|
|
5345 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
|
|
5346
|
|
5347 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
|
|
5348 'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh",
|
|
5349 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or
|
|
5350 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd")
|
|
5351 global
|
|
5352 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
|
|
5353 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
|
|
5354 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
|
10
|
5355 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
|
7
|
5356 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
|
|
5357 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
|
|
5358 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose
|
|
5359 it in quotes. Example: >
|
|
5360 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
|
|
5361 < Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
|
10
|
5362 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
|
7
|
5363 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
|
|
5364 name. And Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
|
|
5365 separators.
|
|
5366 For Dos 32 bits (DJGPP), you can set the $DJSYSFLAGS environment
|
|
5367 variable to change the way external commands are executed. See the
|
|
5368 libc.inf file of DJGPP.
|
|
5369 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
|
|
5370 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
|
|
5371 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
|
|
5372 filtering).
|
|
5373 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
|
|
5374 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
|
|
5375 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
|
|
5376 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
5377 security reasons.
|
|
5378
|
|
5379 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
|
|
5380 'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c", MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
|
|
5381 does not contain "sh" somewhere: "/c")
|
|
5382 global
|
|
5383 {not in Vi}
|
|
5384 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
|
|
5385 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like
|
|
5386 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to
|
|
5387 reduce the need to set this option by the user. It's not used for
|
|
5388 OS/2 (EMX figures this out itself). See |option-backslash| about
|
|
5389 including spaces and backslashes. See |dos-shell|.
|
|
5390 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
5391 security reasons.
|
|
5392
|
|
5393 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
|
|
5394 'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee")
|
|
5395 global
|
|
5396 {not in Vi}
|
|
5397 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
|
|
5398 feature}
|
|
5399 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
|
10
|
5400 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
|
7
|
5401 including spaces and backslashes.
|
|
5402 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
|
|
5403 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
|
|
5404 of this option).
|
|
5405 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly
|
|
5406 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen.
|
|
5407 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
|
|
5408 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
|
|
5409 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
|
|
5410 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "zsh" or "bash" the default becomes
|
|
5411 "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included.
|
|
5412 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
|
|
5413 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
|
|
5414 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
|
|
5415 explicitly set before.
|
|
5416 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
|
|
5417 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
|
|
5418 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
|
|
5419 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
|
|
5420 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
|
|
5421 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
|
|
5422 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
|
|
5423 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
5424 security reasons.
|
|
5425
|
|
5426 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
|
|
5427 'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
|
|
5428 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"")
|
|
5429 global
|
|
5430 {not in Vi}
|
|
5431 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
|
|
5432 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
|
|
5433 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
|
|
5434 probably not useful to set both options.
|
|
5435 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
|
|
5436 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell
|
|
5437 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according
|
|
5438 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the
|
|
5439 user. See |dos-shell|.
|
|
5440 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
5441 security reasons.
|
|
5442
|
|
5443 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
|
|
5444 'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1")
|
|
5445 global
|
|
5446 {not in Vi}
|
|
5447 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
|
|
5448 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
|
|
5449 and backslashes.
|
|
5450 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
|
|
5451 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
|
|
5452 of this option).
|
|
5453 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh"
|
|
5454 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
|
|
5455 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes
|
|
5456 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included.
|
|
5457 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked
|
|
5458 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with
|
|
5459 ".exe" appended are checked for.
|
|
5460 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
|
|
5461 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
|
|
5462 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
|
|
5463 explicitly set before.
|
|
5464 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
|
|
5465 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
|
|
5466 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
5467 security reasons.
|
|
5468
|
|
5469 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
|
|
5470 'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
|
|
5471 global
|
|
5472 {not in Vi} {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
|
|
5473 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
|
|
5474 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or
|
|
5475 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to
|
|
5476 forward slashes by Vim.
|
|
5477 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
|
|
5478 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
|
|
5479 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
|
|
5480 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
|
|
5481 separator. To test if this is so use: >
|
|
5482 if exists('+shellslash')
|
|
5483 <
|
168
|
5484 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
|
|
5485 'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
|
|
5486 global
|
|
5487 {not in Vi}
|
|
5488 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
|
|
5489 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
|
|
5490 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix. You can check it with: >
|
|
5491 :if has("filterpipe")
|
|
5492 < The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
|
|
5493 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
|
|
5494 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
|
|
5495 can be detected.
|
|
5496 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
|
|
5497 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
|
|
5498 'shelltemp' is off.
|
|
5499
|
7
|
5500 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
|
|
5501 'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
|
|
5502 global
|
|
5503 {not in Vi} {only for the Amiga}
|
|
5504 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
|
|
5505 which use a shell.
|
|
5506 0 and 1: always use the shell
|
|
5507 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
|
|
5508 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
|
|
5509 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
|
|
5510
|
|
5511 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
|
|
5512 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
|
|
5513
|
|
5514 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
|
|
5515 'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
|
|
5516 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
|
|
5517 somewhere: "\""
|
|
5518 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
|
|
5519 global
|
|
5520 {not in Vi}
|
|
5521 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
|
|
5522 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
|
|
5523 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
|
|
5524 to set both options.
|
|
5525 This is an empty string by default. Known to be useful for
|
|
5526 third-party shells when using the Win32 version, such as the MKS Korn
|
|
5527 Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted
|
|
5528 according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option
|
|
5529 by the user. See |dos-shell|.
|
|
5530 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
5531 security reasons.
|
|
5532
|
|
5533 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
|
|
5534 'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
|
|
5535 global
|
|
5536 {not in Vi}
|
|
5537 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
|
|
5538 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
|
|
5539 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
|
|
5540 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
5541
|
|
5542 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
|
|
5543 'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
|
|
5544 local to buffer
|
10
|
5545 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
|
7
|
5546 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
|
|
5547
|
|
5548 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
|
168
|
5549 'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "",
|
|
5550 POSIX default: "A")
|
7
|
5551 global
|
|
5552 {not in Vi}
|
|
5553 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
|
|
5554 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
|
|
5555 It is a list of flags:
|
|
5556 flag meaning when present ~
|
|
5557 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)"
|
|
5558 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]"
|
|
5559 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters"
|
|
5560 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]"
|
|
5561 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]"
|
|
5562 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]"
|
|
5563 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message
|
|
5564 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
|
|
5565 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of
|
|
5566 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]".
|
|
5567 a all of the above abbreviations
|
|
5568
|
|
5569 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message
|
|
5570 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on)
|
|
5571 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message.
|
|
5572 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn").
|
|
5573 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search
|
|
5574 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages
|
|
5575 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit
|
|
5576 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column.
|
|
5577 Ignored in Ex mode.
|
|
5578 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to
|
233
|
5579 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle.
|
7
|
5580 Ignored in Ex mode.
|
|
5581 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file
|
|
5582 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file
|
|
5583 is found.
|
|
5584 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|.
|
|
5585
|
|
5586 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
|
|
5587 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
|
|
5588 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
|
|
5589 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
|
|
5590 Useful values:
|
|
5591 shm= No abbreviation of message.
|
|
5592 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
|
|
5593 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
|
|
5594
|
|
5595 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
5596 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
5597
|
|
5598 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
|
|
5599 'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
|
|
5600 local to buffer
|
|
5601 {not in Vi, not in MS-DOS versions}
|
|
5602 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
|
|
5603 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
|
|
5604 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
|
|
5605 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available
|
|
5606 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful
|
|
5607 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
|
|
5608 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this
|
|
5609 option is always on by default.
|
|
5610
|
|
5611 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
|
|
5612 'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
|
|
5613 global
|
|
5614 {not in Vi}
|
|
5615 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
|
|
5616 feature}
|
|
5617 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
|
|
5618 values are "> " or "+++ ".
|
|
5619 Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
|
|
5620 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
|
|
5621 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
|
|
5622 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
|
|
5623 'highlight'.
|
|
5624 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
|
|
5625 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
|
|
5626 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
|
|
5627
|
|
5628 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
|
|
5629 'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix, Vi default:
|
|
5630 off)
|
|
5631 global
|
|
5632 {not in Vi}
|
|
5633 {not available when compiled without the
|
|
5634 |+cmdline_info| feature}
|
10
|
5635 Show (partial) command in status line. Set this option off if your
|
7
|
5636 terminal is slow.
|
|
5637 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
|
|
5638 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
|
|
5639 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
|
|
5640 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters: linesxcolumns.
|
|
5641 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
5642 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
5643
|
|
5644 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
|
|
5645 'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
|
|
5646 global
|
|
5647 {not in Vi}
|
|
5648 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
|
|
5649 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
|
10
|
5650 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
|
7
|
5651 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
|
|
5652 required (coding style permitting).
|
|
5653
|
|
5654 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
|
|
5655 'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
|
|
5656 global
|
|
5657 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
|
|
5658 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
|
|
5659 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
|
|
5660 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
|
|
5661 seen or not). This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
|
|
5662 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
|
|
5663 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
|
|
5664 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
|
|
5665 blinking when showing the match.
|
|
5666 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
|
|
5667 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
|
|
5668 matches.
|
|
5669 Note: For the use of the short form parental guidance is advised.
|
|
5670
|
|
5671 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
|
|
5672 'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
|
|
5673 global
|
|
5674 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
|
|
5675 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
|
|
5676 this message.
|
10
|
5677 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
|
7
|
5678 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
|
|
5679 not set.
|
|
5680 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
5681 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
5682
|
677
|
5683 *'showtabline'* *'stal'*
|
|
5684 'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1)
|
|
5685 global
|
|
5686 {not in Vi}
|
|
5687 {not available when compiled without the +windows
|
|
5688 feature}
|
|
5689 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels
|
|
5690 will be displayed:
|
|
5691 0: never
|
|
5692 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
|
|
5693 2: always
|
|
5694 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages
|
|
5695 line.
|
|
5696 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages.
|
|
5697
|
7
|
5698 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
|
|
5699 'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
|
|
5700 global
|
|
5701 {not in Vi}
|
|
5702 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
|
|
5703 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
|
|
5704 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
|
|
5705 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
|
|
5706 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
|
|
5707 commands.
|
|
5708
|
|
5709 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
|
|
5710 'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
|
|
5711 global
|
|
5712 {not in Vi}
|
|
5713 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
|
534
|
5714 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a
|
|
5715 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero
|
|
5716 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
|
|
5717 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option
|
|
5718 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor
|
|
5719 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too
|
|
5720 close to the beginning of the line.
|
7
|
5721 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
5722
|
|
5723 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
|
|
5724 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
|
|
5725 onto the "extends" character:
|
|
5726
|
|
5727 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
|
|
5728 :set sidescrolloff=1
|
|
5729
|
|
5730
|
|
5731 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
|
|
5732 'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
|
|
5733 global
|
|
5734 {not in Vi}
|
|
5735 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
|
|
5736 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
|
|
5737 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
|
10
|
5738 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc.. After
|
7
|
5739 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
|
|
5740 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
|
|
5741 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
5742
|
|
5743 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
|
|
5744 'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
|
|
5745 local to buffer
|
|
5746 {not in Vi}
|
|
5747 {not available when compiled without the
|
|
5748 |+smartindent| feature}
|
|
5749 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
|
|
5750 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
|
|
5751 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
|
|
5752 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on, setting 'si' has no effect.
|
|
5753 'indentexpr' is a more advanced alternative.
|
|
5754 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
|
|
5755 An indent is automatically inserted:
|
|
5756 - After a line ending in '{'.
|
|
5757 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
|
|
5758 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
|
|
5759 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
|
|
5760 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
|
|
5761 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
|
|
5762 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
|
10
|
5763 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
|
7
|
5764 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
|
|
5765 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
|
|
5766 right.
|
10
|
5767 NOTE: 'smartindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set. When 'paste'
|
7
|
5768 is set smart indenting is disabled.
|
|
5769
|
|
5770 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
|
|
5771 'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
|
|
5772 global
|
|
5773 {not in Vi}
|
|
5774 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
|
648
|
5775 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A
|
|
5776 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the
|
|
5777 line.
|
650
|
5778 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or
|
648
|
5779 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or
|
|
5780 right |shift-left-right|.
|
7
|
5781 What gets inserted (a Tab or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
|
|
5782 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
|
11
|
5783 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
|
7
|
5784 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
5785
|
|
5786 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
|
|
5787 'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
|
|
5788 local to buffer
|
|
5789 {not in Vi}
|
|
5790 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
|
|
5791 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
|
|
5792 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
|
|
5793 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
|
|
5794 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
|
|
5795 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
|
|
5796 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
|
|
5797 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set.
|
|
5798 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
|
|
5799 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
|
|
5800 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
|
|
5801 set.
|
|
5802 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
5803
|
221
|
5804 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
|
|
5805 'spell' boolean (default off)
|
|
5806 local to window
|
|
5807 {not in Vi}
|
|
5808 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
|
|
5809 feature}
|
|
5810 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
|
236
|
5811 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
|
221
|
5812
|
386
|
5813 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
|
389
|
5814 'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
|
386
|
5815 local to buffer
|
|
5816 {not in Vi}
|
|
5817 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
|
|
5818 feature}
|
|
5819 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
|
|
5820 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
|
484
|
5821 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
|
386
|
5822 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
|
|
5823 Only used when 'spell' is set.
|
389
|
5824 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
|
|
5825 including spaces and backslashes.
|
480
|
5826 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
|
|
5827 |set-spc-auto|.
|
386
|
5828
|
314
|
5829 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
|
|
5830 'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
|
|
5831 local to buffer
|
|
5832 {not in Vi}
|
|
5833 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
|
|
5834 feature}
|
|
5835 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
|
401
|
5836 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
|
|
5837 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
|
386
|
5838 *E765*
|
|
5839 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the
|
|
5840 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
|
|
5841 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
|
314
|
5842 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
|
|
5843 you: Using the first "spell" directory in 'runtimepath' that is
|
353
|
5844 writable and the first language name that appears in 'spelllang',
|
|
5845 ignoring the region.
|
|
5846 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
|
|
5847 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
|
|
5848 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
|
|
5849 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
|
|
5850 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
|
|
5851 without region name will be found.
|
336
|
5852 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
5853 security reasons.
|
314
|
5854
|
221
|
5855 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
|
314
|
5856 'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
|
221
|
5857 local to buffer
|
|
5858 {not in Vi}
|
|
5859 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
|
|
5860 feature}
|
353
|
5861 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
|
|
5862 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
|
|
5863 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
|
|
5864 < This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
|
|
5865 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
|
|
5866 The word list name must not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
|
|
5867 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
|
|
5868 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
|
|
5869 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
|
|
5870 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
|
|
5871 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
|
|
5872 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
|
|
5873 Britain.
|
484
|
5874 *E757*
|
419
|
5875 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
|
|
5876 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
|
|
5877 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
|
|
5878 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
|
|
5879 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
|
236
|
5880 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
|
419
|
5881 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
|
|
5882 files twice.
|
353
|
5883 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
|
221
|
5884
|
653
|
5885 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name
|
|
5886 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin
|
|
5887 will ask you if you want to download the file.
|
|
5888
|
480
|
5889 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
|
|
5890 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
|
650
|
5891 up to the first comma, dot or underscore.
|
|
5892 Also see |set-spc-auto|.
|
480
|
5893
|
|
5894
|
344
|
5895 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
|
|
5896 'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
|
|
5897 global
|
|
5898 {not in Vi}
|
|
5899 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
|
|
5900 feature}
|
593
|
5901 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and
|
374
|
5902 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
|
|
5903 items:
|
|
5904
|
|
5905 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
|
|
5906 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
|
|
5907 scoring to improve the ordering.
|
|
5908
|
|
5909 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
|
|
5910 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
|
344
|
5911 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
|
374
|
5912 word. That only works when the language specifies
|
|
5913 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
|
|
5914 better results.
|
|
5915
|
|
5916 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
|
|
5917 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
|
|
5918 simple typing mistakes.
|
|
5919
|
593
|
5920 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|.
|
484
|
5921 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
|
|
5922 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
|
|
5923 minus two.
|
|
5924
|
374
|
5925 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
|
|
5926 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
|
|
5927 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
|
|
5928 Example:
|
|
5929 theribal/terrible ~
|
|
5930 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
|
|
5931 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
|
|
5932 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
|
|
5933 comments.
|
|
5934 The file is used for all languages.
|
|
5935
|
|
5936 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
|
|
5937 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled
|
|
5938 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of
|
|
5939 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score.
|
|
5940 Example:
|
|
5941 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]]
|
593
|
5942 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the
|
374
|
5943 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
|
|
5944 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
|
|
5945 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
|
|
5946 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
|
|
5947 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
|
|
5948
|
|
5949 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
|
|
5950 appear several times in any order. Example: >
|
|
5951 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
|
|
5952 <
|
|
5953 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
5954 security reasons.
|
344
|
5955
|
|
5956
|
7
|
5957 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
|
|
5958 'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
|
|
5959 global
|
|
5960 {not in Vi}
|
|
5961 {not available when compiled without the +windows
|
|
5962 feature}
|
|
5963 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
|
|
5964 one. |:split|
|
|
5965
|
|
5966 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
|
|
5967 'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
|
|
5968 global
|
|
5969 {not in Vi}
|
|
5970 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
|
|
5971 feature}
|
|
5972 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
|
|
5973 current one. |:vsplit|
|
|
5974
|
|
5975 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
|
|
5976 'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
|
|
5977 global
|
|
5978 {not in Vi}
|
|
5979 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
|
11
|
5980 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
|
10
|
5981 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B,
|
11
|
5982 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>"
|
7
|
5983 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing
|
|
5984 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that
|
|
5985 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
|
|
5986 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
|
|
5987 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
|
|
5988 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
5989
|
|
5990 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E541* *E542*
|
|
5991 'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
|
40
|
5992 global or local to window |global-local|
|
7
|
5993 {not in Vi}
|
|
5994 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
|
|
5995 feature}
|
|
5996 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line.
|
|
5997 Also see |status-line|.
|
|
5998
|
|
5999 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
|
|
6000 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
|
|
6001 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
|
|
6002 All fields except the {item} is optional. A single percent sign can
|
|
6003 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified.
|
|
6004
|
|
6005 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
|
|
6006 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
|
|
6007
|
|
6008 field meaning ~
|
233
|
6009 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
|
7
|
6010 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
|
233
|
6011 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
|
7
|
6012 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
|
|
6013 Value must be 50 or less.
|
10
|
6014 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
|
7
|
6015 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
|
|
6016 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
|
|
6017 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
|
|
6018 an exponential notation.
|
|
6019 item A one letter code as described below.
|
|
6020
|
|
6021 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
|
|
6022 second character in "item" is the type:
|
|
6023 N for number
|
|
6024 S for string
|
|
6025 F for flags as described below
|
|
6026 - not applicable
|
|
6027
|
|
6028 item meaning ~
|
|
6029 f S Path to the file in the buffer, relative to current directory.
|
|
6030 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
|
|
6031 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
|
|
6032 m F Modified flag, text is " [+]"; " [-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
|
|
6033 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
|
|
6034 r F Readonly flag, text is " [RO]".
|
|
6035 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
|
|
6036 h F Help buffer flag, text is " [help]".
|
|
6037 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
|
|
6038 w F Preview window flag, text is " [Preview]".
|
|
6039 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
|
|
6040 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., " [vim]". See 'filetype'.
|
|
6041 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
|
|
6042 {not available when compiled without |+autocmd| feature}
|
|
6043 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
|
|
6044 being used: "<keymap>"
|
|
6045 n N Buffer number.
|
|
6046 b N Value of byte under cursor.
|
|
6047 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
|
|
6048 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
|
|
6049 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
|
|
6050 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
|
|
6051 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
|
233
|
6052 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
|
7
|
6053 l N Line number.
|
|
6054 L N Number of lines in buffer.
|
|
6055 c N Column number.
|
|
6056 v N Virtual column number.
|
10
|
6057 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
|
7
|
6058 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
|
|
6059 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
|
|
6060 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length.
|
233
|
6061 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
|
7
|
6062 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
|
|
6063 { NF Evaluate expression between '{' and '}' and substitute result.
|
625
|
6064 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'.
|
7
|
6065 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
|
|
6066 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
|
|
6067 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
|
|
6068 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
|
|
6069 No width fields allowed.
|
|
6070 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items.
|
|
6071 No width fields allowed.
|
|
6072 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
|
233
|
6073 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
|
7
|
6074 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied
|
|
6075 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
|
|
6076 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
|
|
6077
|
|
6078 Display of flags are controlled by the following heuristic:
|
|
6079 If a flag text starts with comma it is assumed that it wants to
|
10
|
6080 separate itself from anything but preceding plaintext. If it starts
|
7
|
6081 with a space it is assumed that it wants to separate itself from
|
|
6082 anything but other flags. That is: A leading comma is removed if the
|
|
6083 preceding character stems from plaintext. A leading space is removed
|
233
|
6084 if the preceding character stems from another active flag. This will
|
7
|
6085 make a nice display when flags are used like in the examples below.
|
|
6086
|
233
|
6087 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
|
7
|
6088 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
|
|
6089 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
|
|
6090 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
|
|
6091 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
|
|
6092 <
|
|
6093 Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
|
|
6094 line is displayed. The current buffer and current window will be set
|
|
6095 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
|
233
|
6096 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
|
7
|
6097 The variable "actual_curbuf" is set to the 'bufnr()' number of the
|
634
|
6098 real current buffer.
|
|
6099
|
|
6100 The 'statusline' option may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
|
6101 |sandbox-option|.
|
|
6102
|
|
6103 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
|
6104 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
|
7
|
6105
|
|
6106 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
|
|
6107 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
|
|
6108 setting an option without changing its value. Example: >
|
|
6109 :let &ro = &ro
|
|
6110
|
|
6111 < A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
|
|
6112 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
|
|
6113 described above.
|
|
6114
|
199
|
6115 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
|
7
|
6116 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
|
|
6117 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim -u NONE" to get it right.
|
|
6118
|
|
6119 Examples:
|
|
6120 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
|
|
6121 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
|
|
6122 < Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
|
|
6123 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
|
|
6124 < Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
|
|
6125 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
|
|
6126 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
|
|
6127 < Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
|
|
6128 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
|
|
6129 < In the |:autocmd|'s: >
|
|
6130 :let b:gzflag = 1
|
|
6131 < And: >
|
|
6132 :unlet b:gzflag
|
|
6133 < And define this function: >
|
|
6134 :function VarExists(var, val)
|
|
6135 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
|
|
6136 :endfunction
|
|
6137 <
|
|
6138 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
|
|
6139 'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
|
|
6140 global
|
|
6141 {not in Vi}
|
|
6142 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
|
|
6143 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
|
10
|
6144 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
|
|
6145 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
|
7
|
6146 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
|
|
6147 including spaces and backslashes).
|
|
6148 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
|
|
6149 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
|
|
6150 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
|
|
6151 uses another default.
|
|
6152
|
|
6153 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
|
|
6154 'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
|
|
6155 local to buffer
|
|
6156 {not in Vi}
|
|
6157 {not available when compiled without the
|
|
6158 |+file_in_path| feature}
|
|
6159 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
|
|
6160 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
|
|
6161 :set suffixesadd=.java
|
|
6162 <
|
|
6163 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
|
|
6164 'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
|
|
6165 local to buffer
|
|
6166 {not in Vi}
|
10
|
6167 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
|
7
|
6168 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
|
|
6169 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
|
|
6170 Careful: All text will be in memory:
|
|
6171 - Don't use this for big files.
|
|
6172 - Recovery will be impossible!
|
|
6173 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
|
|
6174 'swapfile' is set.
|
|
6175 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
|
|
6176 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
|
|
6177 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
|
|
6178 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
|
|
6179
|
|
6180 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
|
|
6181 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
|
|
6182
|
|
6183 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
|
|
6184 'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
|
|
6185 global
|
|
6186 {not in Vi}
|
|
6187 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
|
10
|
6188 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
|
7
|
6189 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
|
|
6190 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
|
|
6191 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
|
|
6192 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
|
|
6193 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
|
|
6194 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
|
|
6195 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
|
36
|
6196 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
|
7
|
6197
|
|
6198 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
|
|
6199 'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
|
|
6200 global
|
|
6201 {not in Vi}
|
|
6202 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
|
|
6203 Possible values (comma separated list):
|
|
6204 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that
|
|
6205 contains the specified buffer (if there is one).
|
|
6206 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows.
|
|
6207 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when
|
|
6208 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is
|
|
6209 also used in all buffer related split commands, for
|
|
6210 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind".
|
|
6211 split If included, split the current window before loading
|
233
|
6212 a buffer. Otherwise: do not split, use current window.
|
7
|
6213 Supported in |quickfix| commands that display errors.
|
|
6214
|
410
|
6215 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
|
|
6216 'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
|
|
6217 local to buffer
|
|
6218 {not in Vi}
|
|
6219 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
|
|
6220 feature}
|
419
|
6221 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
|
|
6222 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
|
|
6223 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
|
410
|
6224 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
|
|
6225 long line.
|
|
6226 Set to zero to remove the limit.
|
|
6227
|
7
|
6228 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
|
|
6229 'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
|
|
6230 local to buffer
|
|
6231 {not in Vi}
|
|
6232 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
|
|
6233 feature}
|
|
6234 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
|
|
6235 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
|
|
6236 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
|
|
6237 b:current_syntax variable does).
|
|
6238 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
|
410
|
6239 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file: >
|
7
|
6240 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */
|
|
6241 < To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
|
|
6242 :set syntax=OFF
|
|
6243 < To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
|
|
6244 'filetype' option: >
|
|
6245 :set syntax=ON
|
|
6246 < What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
|
|
6247 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
|
|
6248 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
|
|
6249 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
|
36
|
6250 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
|
7
|
6251
|
674
|
6252 *'tabline'* *'tal'*
|
677
|
6253 'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty)
|
674
|
6254 global
|
|
6255 {not in Vi}
|
|
6256 {not available when compiled without the +windows
|
|
6257 feature}
|
677
|
6258 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages
|
|
6259 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default
|
|
6260 tab pages line. |tab-page|
|
|
6261
|
|
6262 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline'
|
|
6263 option and only when there is no GUI implementation for tabs.
|
|
6264
|
|
6265 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use
|
|
6266 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out
|
|
6267 the text to be displayed.
|
|
6268
|
|
6269 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others
|
|
6270 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows.
|
|
6271
|
674
|
6272
|
7
|
6273 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
|
|
6274 'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
|
|
6275 local to buffer
|
|
6276 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
|
|
6277 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option.
|
|
6278
|
|
6279 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
|
|
6280 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it).
|
|
6281
|
|
6282 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim:
|
|
6283 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
|
|
6284 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
|
|
6285 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing Tab and BS will
|
|
6286 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
|
|
6287 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
|
|
6288 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
|
|
6289 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
|
|
6290 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
|
10
|
6291 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
|
7
|
6292 works when using Vim to edit the file.
|
|
6293 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
|
|
6294 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
|
|
6295 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
|
|
6296 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
|
|
6297 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
|
|
6298 changed.
|
|
6299
|
|
6300 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
|
|
6301 'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
|
|
6302 global
|
|
6303 {not in Vi}
|
|
6304 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
|
10
|
6305 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
|
7
|
6306 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
|
|
6307 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
|
|
6308 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
|
|
6309 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
|
|
6310 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
|
|
6311
|
|
6312 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
|
10
|
6313 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
|
7
|
6314 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
|
|
6315 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
|
|
6316
|
|
6317 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
|
|
6318 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
|
|
6319 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some command/
|
|
6320 < [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
|
|
6321
|
|
6322 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
|
|
6323 files listed in 'tags', and 'ignorecase' is set or a pattern is used
|
|
6324 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
|
|
6325 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
|
|
6326 be found in the retry.
|
|
6327
|
22
|
6328 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
|
7
|
6329 linear search can be avoided for the 'ignorecase' case. Use a value
|
|
6330 of '2' in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be
|
|
6331 case-fold sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in
|
|
6332 the command: "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version
|
|
6333 5.3 or higher the -f or --fold-case-sort switch can be used for this
|
|
6334 as well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this to work.
|
|
6335
|
|
6336 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
|
|
6337 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
|
|
6338 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
|
|
6339 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
|
|
6340 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
|
|
6341 must be included in the tags file.
|
|
6342 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
|
|
6343 command-line completion and ":help").
|
|
6344 {Vi: always uses binary search in some versions}
|
|
6345
|
|
6346 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
|
|
6347 'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
|
|
6348 global
|
|
6349 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
|
|
6350
|
|
6351 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
|
|
6352 'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
|
|
6353 global
|
|
6354 {not in Vi}
|
|
6355 If on and using a tag file in another directory, file names in that
|
|
6356 tag file are relative to the directory where the tag file is.
|
|
6357 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
6358 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
6359
|
|
6360 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
|
|
6361 'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
|
|
6362 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
|
|
6363 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
6364 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
|
|
6365 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash
|
|
6366 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes).
|
|
6367 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
|
|
6368 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
|
|
6369 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
|
|
6370 |tags-option|.
|
|
6371 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
|
|
6372 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. {not available when compiled
|
|
6373 without the |+path_extra| feature}
|
515
|
6374 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
|
|
6375 actually used.
|
7
|
6376 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
|
|
6377 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
|
|
6378 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
|
|
6379 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
|
|
6380 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
|
|
6381 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
|
|
6382 uses another default.
|
|
6383 {Vi: default is "tags /usr/lib/tags"}
|
|
6384
|
|
6385 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
|
|
6386 'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
|
|
6387 global
|
|
6388 {not in all versions of Vi}
|
|
6389 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
|
|
6390 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
|
|
6391 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
|
|
6392 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
|
|
6393 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
|
|
6394 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
|
|
6395 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
|
|
6396
|
|
6397 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
|
|
6398 'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
|
|
6399 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
|
|
6400 on Amiga: "amiga"
|
|
6401 on BeOS: "beos-ansi"
|
|
6402 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
|
|
6403 on MiNT: "vt52"
|
|
6404 on MS-DOS: "pcterm"
|
|
6405 on OS/2: "os2ansi"
|
|
6406 on Unix: "ansi"
|
|
6407 on VMS: "ansi"
|
|
6408 on Win 32: "win32")
|
|
6409 global
|
|
6410 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
|
|
6411 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
|
|
6412 For example: >
|
|
6413 :set term=$TERM
|
|
6414 < See |termcap|.
|
|
6415
|
|
6416 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
|
|
6417 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
|
|
6418 'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
|
|
6419 global
|
|
6420 {not in Vi}
|
|
6421 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
|
|
6422 feature}
|
|
6423 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
|
|
6424 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
|
|
6425 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
|
|
6426 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
|
|
6427 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
|
|
6428 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
|
|
6429 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
|
|
6430 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
|
|
6431 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
|
|
6432
|
|
6433 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
|
|
6434 'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ 2 GUI: "utf-8"; with
|
|
6435 Macintosh GUI: "macroman")
|
|
6436 global
|
|
6437 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
|
|
6438 feature}
|
|
6439 {not in Vi}
|
|
6440 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
|
|
6441 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
|
|
6442 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the
|
|
6443 display).
|
|
6444 In the Win32 console version the default value is the console codepage
|
|
6445 when it differs from the ANSI codepage.
|
|
6446 *E617*
|
|
6447 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ 2 GUI. After the GUI has been
|
|
6448 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
|
|
6449 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
|
|
6450 message is shown.
|
|
6451 For the Win32 GUI 'termencoding' is not used for typed characters,
|
|
6452 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
|
|
6453 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
|
|
6454 This is the normal value.
|
|
6455 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
|
|
6456 |encoding-table|.
|
|
6457 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
|
|
6458 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
|
|
6459 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
|
|
6460 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
|
|
6461 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
|
|
6462 :let &termencoding = &encoding
|
|
6463 :set encoding=utf-8
|
|
6464 < You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
|
|
6465
|
|
6466 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
|
|
6467 'terse' boolean (default off)
|
|
6468 global
|
|
6469 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
|
|
6470 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
|
|
6471 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
|
|
6472 shortens a lot of messages}
|
|
6473
|
|
6474 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
|
|
6475 'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
|
|
6476 global
|
|
6477 {not in Vi}
|
|
6478 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
|
|
6479 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
|
|
6480 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
|
|
6481 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
|
|
6482 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
6483 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
6484
|
|
6485 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
|
|
6486 'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on,
|
|
6487 others: default off)
|
|
6488 local to buffer
|
|
6489 {not in Vi}
|
|
6490 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
|
|
6491 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
|
|
6492 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
|
|
6493 "unix".
|
|
6494
|
|
6495 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
|
|
6496 'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
|
|
6497 local to buffer
|
|
6498 {not in Vi}
|
|
6499 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
|
|
6500 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
|
10
|
6501 this. 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set. When
|
|
6502 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
|
7
|
6503 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
|
|
6504 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
6505
|
|
6506 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
|
|
6507 'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
|
|
6508 global or local to buffer |global-local|
|
|
6509 {not in Vi}
|
|
6510 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
|
10
|
6511 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. Each line in
|
7
|
6512 the file should contain words with similar meaning, separated by
|
|
6513 non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). Maximum line
|
|
6514 length is 510 bytes.
|
|
6515 To obtain a file to be used here, check out the wordlist FAQ at
|
|
6516 http://www.hyphenologist.co.uk .
|
10
|
6517 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
|
7
|
6518 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
|
|
6519 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
|
|
6520 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
|
|
6521 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
|
|
6522 uses another default.
|
|
6523 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
|
|
6524
|
|
6525 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
|
|
6526 'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
|
|
6527 global
|
|
6528 {not in Vi}
|
|
6529 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
|
|
6530 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
6531
|
|
6532 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
|
|
6533 'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
|
|
6534 global
|
|
6535 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
|
|
6536 'ttimeout' boolean (default off)
|
|
6537 global
|
|
6538 {not in Vi}
|
|
6539 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
|
|
6540 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
|
|
6541
|
|
6542 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
|
|
6543 off off do not time out
|
|
6544 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
|
|
6545 off on time out on key codes
|
|
6546
|
|
6547 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
|
|
6548 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
|
|
6549 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
|
|
6550 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
|
|
6551 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
|
|
6552 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
|
|
6553 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
|
|
6554 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
|
|
6555 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
|
|
6556 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
|
|
6557 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
|
|
6558 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
|
|
6559 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
|
|
6560 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
|
|
6561 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
|
|
6562 reset the 'timeout' option.
|
|
6563
|
|
6564 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
|
6565
|
|
6566 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
|
|
6567 'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
|
|
6568 global
|
|
6569 {not in all versions of Vi}
|
|
6570 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
|
|
6571 'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1)
|
|
6572 global
|
|
6573 {not in Vi}
|
|
6574 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
|
|
6575 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
|
|
6576 when part of a command has been typed.
|
|
6577 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
|
|
6578 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
|
|
6579 a non-negative number.
|
|
6580
|
|
6581 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
|
|
6582 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
|
|
6583 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
|
|
6584
|
|
6585 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
|
|
6586 tell so. A useful setting would be >
|
|
6587 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
|
|
6588 < (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
|
|
6589 a tenth of a second).
|
|
6590
|
|
6591 *'title'* *'notitle'*
|
|
6592 'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
|
|
6593 global
|
|
6594 {not in Vi}
|
|
6595 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
|
|
6596 feature}
|
|
6597 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
|
|
6598 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
|
|
6599 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
|
|
6600 Where:
|
|
6601 filename the name of the file being edited
|
|
6602 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
|
|
6603 + indicates the file was modified
|
|
6604 = indicates the file is read-only
|
|
6605 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
|
|
6606 (path) is the path of the file being edited
|
|
6607 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
|
|
6608 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
|
|
6609 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
|
|
6610 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
|
|
6611 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
|
|
6612 *X11*
|
|
6613 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
|
|
6614 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
|
|
6615 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
|
|
6616 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
|
|
6617 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
|
|
6618 will not work (except in the GUI).
|
|
6619 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
|
|
6620 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
|
|
6621 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command:
|
|
6622 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
|
|
6623 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
|
|
6624 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
|
|
6625 exiting Vim.
|
|
6626
|
|
6627 *'titlelen'*
|
|
6628 'titlelen' number (default 85)
|
|
6629 global
|
|
6630 {not in Vi}
|
|
6631 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
|
|
6632 feature}
|
|
6633 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
|
10
|
6634 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
|
|
6635 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
|
7
|
6636 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
|
|
6637 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
|
|
6638 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
|
|
6639 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
|
|
6640 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
|
|
6641 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
|
|
6642
|
|
6643 *'titleold'*
|
|
6644 'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
|
|
6645 global
|
|
6646 {not in Vi}
|
|
6647 {only available when compiled with the |+title|
|
|
6648 feature}
|
|
6649 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
|
|
6650 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
|
|
6651 'titlestring' is not empty.
|
36
|
6652 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
6653 security reasons.
|
7
|
6654 *'titlestring'*
|
|
6655 'titlestring' string (default "")
|
|
6656 global
|
|
6657 {not in Vi}
|
|
6658 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
|
|
6659 feature}
|
|
6660 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
|
|
6661 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
|
|
6662 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
|
|
6663 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
|
|
6664 non-empty 't_ts' option).
|
|
6665 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
|
|
6666 be restored if possible |X11|.
|
|
6667 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
|
|
6668 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'.
|
|
6669 Example: >
|
|
6670 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p")
|
|
6671 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
|
|
6672 < The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
|
|
6673 of the available space.
|
|
6674 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
|
|
6675 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
|
|
6676 < Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
|
10
|
6677 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
|
7
|
6678 separating space only when needed.
|
|
6679 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
|
|
6680 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
|
|
6681 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
|
|
6682
|
|
6683 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
|
|
6684 'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
|
|
6685 global
|
|
6686 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and
|
|
6687 |+GUI_Photon|}
|
10
|
6688 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
|
7
|
6689 possible values are:
|
|
6690 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
|
|
6691 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
|
|
6692 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
|
10
|
6693 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
|
7
|
6694 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
|
|
6695 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
|
|
6696 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
|
|
6697
|
|
6698 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
|
|
6699 following: >
|
|
6700 :set tb=icons,text
|
|
6701 < Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
|
|
6702 will show icons if both are requested.
|
|
6703
|
|
6704 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
|
|
6705 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
|
|
6706 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
|
|
6707 :set guioptions-=T
|
|
6708 < Also see |gui-toolbar|.
|
|
6709
|
|
6710 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
|
|
6711 'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
|
|
6712 global
|
|
6713 {not in Vi}
|
|
6714 {only in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
|
|
6715 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
|
|
6716 tiny Use tiny toolbar icons.
|
|
6717 small Use small toolbar icons (default).
|
|
6718 medium Use medium-sized toolbar icons.
|
|
6719 large Use large toolbar icons.
|
|
6720 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
|
|
6721 the current theme. Common dimensions are large=32x32, medium=24x24,
|
|
6722 small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
|
|
6723
|
|
6724 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
|
|
6725 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
|
|
6726
|
|
6727 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
|
|
6728 'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
|
|
6729 global
|
|
6730 {not in Vi}
|
|
6731 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
|
|
6732 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
|
|
6733 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
|
|
6734 the change to take effect, for example: >
|
|
6735 :set notbi term=$TERM
|
|
6736 < See also |termcap|.
|
|
6737 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
|
|
6738 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
|
|
6739 xterm entries...).
|
|
6740
|
|
6741 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
|
|
6742 'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm,
|
|
6743 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or
|
|
6744 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in
|
|
6745 a DOS console)
|
|
6746 global
|
|
6747 {not in Vi}
|
|
6748 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
|
|
6749 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
|
|
6750 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
|
|
6751 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
|
|
6752 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
|
|
6753 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
|
|
6754 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
|
|
6755
|
|
6756 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
|
|
6757 'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
|
|
6758 global
|
|
6759 {not in Vi}
|
|
6760 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
|
|
6761 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
|
|
6762 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
|
|
6763 Currently these three strings are valid:
|
|
6764 *xterm-mouse*
|
|
6765 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
|
|
6766 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
|
|
6767 "s" = button state
|
|
6768 "c" = column plus 33
|
|
6769 "r" = row plus 33
|
189
|
6770 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec" for a
|
|
6771 solution.
|
7
|
6772 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
|
|
6773 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
|
|
6774 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
|
180
|
6775 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
|
7
|
6776 work. See below for how Vim detects this
|
|
6777 automatically.
|
|
6778 *netterm-mouse*
|
|
6779 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. The mouse generates
|
|
6780 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
|
|
6781 for the row and column.
|
|
6782 *dec-mouse*
|
|
6783 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
|
|
6784 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
|
189
|
6785 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
|
|
6786 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
|
7
|
6787 *jsbterm-mouse*
|
|
6788 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
|
|
6789 *pterm-mouse*
|
|
6790 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
|
|
6791
|
|
6792 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
|
|
6793 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm|.
|
|
6794 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
|
|
6795 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
|
|
6796 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
|
|
6797 "xterm" (because the xterm and dec mouse codes conflict).
|
|
6798 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
|
|
6799 set to a name that starts with "xterm", and 'ttymouse' is not "xterm"
|
|
6800 or "xterm2" already. The main use of this option is to set it to
|
|
6801 "xterm", when the terminal name doesn't start with "xterm", but it can
|
|
6802 handle xterm mouse codes.
|
|
6803 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
|
|
6804 95 of higher. This only works when compiled with the |+termresponse|
|
|
6805 feature and if |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the
|
|
6806 xterm version number. Otherwise "xterm2" must be set explicitly.
|
|
6807 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" automatically, set
|
|
6808 t_RV to an empty string: >
|
|
6809 :set t_RV=
|
|
6810 <
|
|
6811 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
|
|
6812 'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
|
|
6813 global
|
|
6814 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
|
|
6815 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
|
|
6816 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
|
|
6817 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
|
|
6818
|
|
6819 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
|
|
6820 'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
|
|
6821 global
|
|
6822 Alias for 'term', see above.
|
|
6823
|
|
6824 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
|
|
6825 'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS,
|
|
6826 Win32 and OS/2)
|
|
6827 global
|
|
6828 {not in Vi}
|
|
6829 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
|
|
6830 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used
|
|
6831 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory).
|
|
6832 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
|
|
6833 itself: >
|
|
6834 set ul=0
|
|
6835 < But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
|
|
6836 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
|
|
6837 Set to a negative number for no undo at all: >
|
|
6838 set ul=-1
|
|
6839 < This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
|
|
6840 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
|
|
6841
|
|
6842 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
|
|
6843 'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
|
|
6844 global
|
|
6845 {not in Vi}
|
|
6846 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
|
|
6847 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
|
|
6848 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
|
|
6849 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
|
|
6850 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
|
|
6851 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
|
|
6852 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
|
|
6853 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
|
|
6854 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
|
|
6855 Also see |'swapsync'|.
|
|
6856 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
|
|
6857 or "nowrite".
|
|
6858
|
|
6859 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
|
|
6860 'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
|
|
6861 global
|
|
6862 {not in Vi}
|
|
6863 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
|
|
6864 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
|
|
6865 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
|
|
6866
|
|
6867 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
|
|
6868 'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
|
|
6869 global
|
|
6870 {not in Vi, although some versions have a boolean
|
|
6871 verbose option}
|
|
6872 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
|
|
6873 Currently, these messages are given:
|
|
6874 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
|
|
6875 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
|
|
6876 >= 5 Every searched tags file.
|
|
6877 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
|
|
6878 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
|
|
6879 >= 12 Every executed function.
|
|
6880 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
|
|
6881 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
|
|
6882 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters).
|
|
6883
|
|
6884 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
|
|
6885 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
|
|
6886
|
293
|
6887 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
|
|
6888 displayed.
|
|
6889
|
|
6890 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
|
|
6891 'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
|
|
6892 global
|
|
6893 {not in Vi}
|
|
6894 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
|
|
6895 When the file exists messages are appended.
|
|
6896 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
|
|
6897 empty.
|
|
6898 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
|
|
6899 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
|
|
6900 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
|
|
6901
|
7
|
6902 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
|
|
6903 'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32:
|
|
6904 "$VIM/vimfiles/view",
|
|
6905 for Unix: "~/.vim/view",
|
|
6906 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view"
|
|
6907 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view"
|
|
6908 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view")
|
|
6909 global
|
|
6910 {not in Vi}
|
|
6911 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
|
|
6912 feature}
|
|
6913 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
|
|
6914 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
6915 security reasons.
|
|
6916
|
|
6917 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
|
|
6918 'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor")
|
|
6919 global
|
|
6920 {not in Vi}
|
|
6921 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
|
|
6922 feature}
|
|
6923 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated
|
10
|
6924 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
|
7
|
6925 word save and restore ~
|
|
6926 cursor cursor position in file and in window
|
|
6927 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
|
|
6928 fold options
|
|
6929 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
|
|
6930 global values for local options)
|
|
6931 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
|
|
6932 slashes
|
|
6933 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
|
|
6934 on Windows or DOS
|
|
6935
|
|
6936 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files
|
|
6937 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
|
|
6938 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
|
|
6939
|
|
6940 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
|
|
6941 'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS,
|
|
6942 Windows and OS/2: '20,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
|
|
6943 for Amiga: '20,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
|
|
6944 for others: '20,<50,s10,h)
|
|
6945 global
|
|
6946 {not in Vi}
|
|
6947 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
|
|
6948 feature}
|
|
6949 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
|
10
|
6950 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). The string should be a comma
|
7
|
6951 separated list of parameters, each consisting of a single character
|
|
6952 identifying the particular parameter, followed by a number or string
|
|
6953 which specifies the value of that parameter. If a particular
|
|
6954 character is left out, then the default value is used for that
|
|
6955 parameter. The following is a list of the identifying characters and
|
|
6956 the effect of their value.
|
|
6957 CHAR VALUE ~
|
|
6958 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
|
|
6959 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
|
|
6960 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
|
75
|
6961 and "_K_L_M" are not. Only String and Number types are
|
|
6962 stored.
|
7
|
6963 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
|
|
6964 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
|
|
6965 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
|
|
6966 start of a comment!
|
|
6967 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
|
|
6968 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
|
|
6969 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
|
10
|
6970 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Buffers
|
7
|
6971 without a file name and buffers for help files are not written
|
|
6972 to the viminfo file.
|
23
|
6973 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
|
|
6974 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
|
|
6975 buffers are stored.
|
7
|
6976 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
|
|
6977 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
|
|
6978 'viminfo' is non-empty.
|
|
6979 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
|
|
6980 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
|
|
6981 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
|
10
|
6982 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
|
7
|
6983 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
|
|
6984 'history' is used.
|
|
6985 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
|
10
|
6986 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
|
7
|
6987 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
|
|
6988 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
|
|
6989 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
|
|
6990 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
|
|
6991 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
|
10
|
6992 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
|
7
|
6993 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
|
|
6994 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
|
233
|
6995 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
|
7
|
6996 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
|
|
6997 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
|
10
|
6998 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
|
7
|
6999 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
|
|
7000 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
|
|
7001 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
|
|
7002 has been used since the last search command.
|
|
7003 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
|
|
7004 the 'n'. Must be the last one! If the "-i" argument was
|
|
7005 given when starting Vim, that file name overrides the one
|
|
7006 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are expanded
|
|
7007 when opening the file, not when setting the option.
|
|
7008 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
|
|
7009 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
|
|
7010 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
|
|
7011 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you
|
|
7012 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
|
|
7013 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
|
|
7014 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
|
|
7015 characters.
|
|
7016 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
|
|
7017 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
|
|
7018 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
|
|
7019 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
|
|
7020
|
|
7021 Example: >
|
|
7022 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
|
|
7023 <
|
|
7024 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
|
|
7025 edited.
|
|
7026 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
|
|
7027 remembered.
|
|
7028 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
|
|
7029 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
|
|
7030 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
|
|
7031 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
|
|
7032 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
|
|
7033 previous search and substitute patterns.
|
|
7034 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
|
|
7035 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
|
|
7036
|
|
7037 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
|
|
7038 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
|
|
7039
|
|
7040 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
|
7041 security reasons.
|
|
7042
|
|
7043 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
|
|
7044 'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
|
|
7045 global
|
|
7046 {not in Vi}
|
|
7047 {not available when compiled without the
|
|
7048 |+virtualedit| feature}
|
|
7049 A comma separated list of these words:
|
|
7050 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
|
|
7051 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
|
|
7052 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
|
|
7053 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
|
|
7054 no actual character. This can be halfway into a Tab or beyond the end
|
|
7055 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
|
|
7056 editing a table.
|
|
7057
|
|
7058 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
|
|
7059 'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
|
|
7060 global
|
|
7061 {not in Vi}
|
|
7062 Use visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
|
|
7063 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
|
|
7064 use ":set vb t_vb=".
|
|
7065 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
|
|
7066 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
|
|
7067 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
|
|
7068 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
|
|
7069 where 40 is the time in msec.
|
|
7070 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
|
|
7071 Also see 'errorbells'.
|
|
7072
|
|
7073 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
|
|
7074 'warn' boolean (default on)
|
|
7075 global
|
|
7076 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
|
|
7077 has been changed.
|
|
7078
|
|
7079 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
|
|
7080 'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
|
|
7081 global
|
|
7082 {not in Vi}
|
667
|
7083 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option.
|
7
|
7084 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
|
|
7085 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
|
|
7086 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
|
|
7087
|
|
7088 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
|
|
7089 'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
|
|
7090 global
|
|
7091 {not in Vi}
|
|
7092 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
|
|
7093 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
|
|
7094 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
|
|
7095 char key mode ~
|
|
7096 b <BS> Normal and Visual
|
|
7097 s <Space> Normal and Visual
|
|
7098 h "h" Normal and Visual
|
|
7099 l "l" Normal and Visual
|
|
7100 < <Left> Normal and Visual
|
|
7101 > <Right> Normal and Visual
|
|
7102 ~ "~" Normal
|
|
7103 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
|
|
7104 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
|
|
7105 For example: >
|
|
7106 :set ww=<,>,[,]
|
|
7107 < allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
|
|
7108 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
|
|
7109 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
|
|
7110 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
|
|
7111 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
|
|
7112 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
|
|
7113 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
|
|
7114 cursor.
|
|
7115 When 'l' is included, you get a side effect: "yl" on an empty line
|
|
7116 will include the <EOL>, so that "p" will insert a new line.
|
|
7117 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
7118 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
7119
|
|
7120 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
|
|
7121 'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
|
|
7122 global
|
|
7123 {not in Vi}
|
|
7124 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
|
|
7125 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
|
|
7126 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
|
|
7127 'wildcharm' for that.
|
|
7128 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: >
|
|
7129 :set wc=<Esc>
|
|
7130 < NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
7131 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
|
|
7132
|
|
7133 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
|
|
7134 'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
|
|
7135 global
|
|
7136 {not in Vi}
|
|
7137 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
|
233
|
7138 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
|
|
7139 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
|
7
|
7140 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
|
|
7141 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
|
|
7142 :set wcm=<C-Z>
|
|
7143 :cmap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
|
|
7144 < Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
|
|
7145
|
|
7146 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
|
|
7147 'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
|
|
7148 global
|
|
7149 {not in Vi}
|
|
7150 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
|
|
7151 feature}
|
|
7152 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
|
|
7153 patterns is ignored when completing file or directory names.
|
|
7154 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
|
|
7155 Also see 'suffixes'.
|
|
7156 Example: >
|
|
7157 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
|
|
7158 < The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
|
|
7159 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
|
|
7160 uses another default.
|
|
7161
|
|
7162 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
|
|
7163 'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off)
|
|
7164 global
|
|
7165 {not in Vi}
|
|
7166 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu|
|
|
7167 feature}
|
|
7168 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
|
|
7169 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
|
|
7170 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the
|
|
7171 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is
|
|
7172 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
|
|
7173 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
|
|
7174 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
|
|
7175 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
|
|
7176 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
|
|
7177 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
|
|
7178 as needed.
|
|
7179 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
|
|
7180 for selecting a completion.
|
|
7181 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special
|
|
7182 meanings:
|
|
7183
|
|
7184 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
|
|
7185 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
|
|
7186 subdirectory or submenu.
|
|
7187 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
|
|
7188 dot: move into a submenu.
|
|
7189 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
|
|
7190 parent directory or parent menu.
|
|
7191
|
|
7192 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
|
|
7193
|
|
7194 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
|
|
7195 of selecting a different match, use this: >
|
|
7196 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
|
|
7197 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
|
|
7198 <
|
|
7199 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
|
|
7200 |hl-WildMenu|.
|
|
7201
|
|
7202 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
|
|
7203 'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
|
|
7204 global
|
|
7205 {not in Vi}
|
|
7206 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with
|
10
|
7207 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each
|
7
|
7208 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar. The
|
|
7209 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar',
|
|
7210 The second part for the second use, etc.
|
|
7211 These are the possible values for each part:
|
|
7212 "" Complete only the first match.
|
|
7213 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match,
|
|
7214 the original string is used and then the first match
|
|
7215 again.
|
|
7216 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't
|
|
7217 result in a longer string, use the next part.
|
|
7218 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is
|
|
7219 enabled.
|
|
7220 "list" When more than one match, list all matches.
|
|
7221 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and
|
|
7222 complete first match.
|
|
7223 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and
|
|
7224 complete till longest common string.
|
|
7225 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases.
|
|
7226
|
|
7227 Examples: >
|
|
7228 :set wildmode=full
|
233
|
7229 < Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) >
|
7
|
7230 :set wildmode=longest,full
|
|
7231 < Complete longest common string, then each full match >
|
|
7232 :set wildmode=list:full
|
|
7233 < List all matches and complete each full match >
|
|
7234 :set wildmode=list,full
|
|
7235 < List all matches without completing, then each full match >
|
|
7236 :set wildmode=longest,list
|
|
7237 < Complete longest common string, then list alternatives.
|
|
7238
|
40
|
7239 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
|
|
7240 'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
|
|
7241 global
|
|
7242 {not in Vi}
|
|
7243 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
|
|
7244 feature}
|
|
7245 A list of words that change how command line completion is done.
|
|
7246 Currently only one word is allowed:
|
|
7247 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
|
|
7248 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
|
|
7249 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
|
|
7250 d #define
|
|
7251 f function
|
|
7252 Also see |cmdline-completion|.
|
|
7253
|
7
|
7254 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
|
|
7255 'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
|
|
7256 global
|
|
7257 {not in Vi}
|
|
7258 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
|
|
7259 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
|
|
7260 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
|
|
7261 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
|
|
7262 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
|
|
7263 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
|
|
7264 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
|
|
7265 done with the |:simalt| command.
|
|
7266 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
|
|
7267 combinations cannot be mapped.
|
|
7268 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
|
10
|
7269 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
|
7
|
7270 keys can be mapped.
|
|
7271 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
|
|
7272 key is never used for the menu.
|
36
|
7273 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
|
|
7274 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
|
7
|
7275
|
164
|
7276 *'window'* *'wi'*
|
|
7277 'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
|
|
7278 global
|
|
7279 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window,
|
|
7280 use 'lines' for that.
|
179
|
7281 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the
|
|
7282 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll
|
|
7283 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
|
164
|
7284 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
|
|
7285 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
|
|
7286 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than
|
|
7287 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
|
|
7288 {Vi also uses the option to specify the number of displayed lines}
|
|
7289
|
7
|
7290 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
|
|
7291 'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
|
|
7292 global
|
|
7293 {not in Vi}
|
|
7294 {not available when compiled without the +windows
|
|
7295 feature}
|
|
7296 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
|
10
|
7297 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
|
7
|
7298 current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of the
|
|
7299 height of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
|
|
7300 always fill the screen (although this has the drawback that ":all"
|
|
7301 will create only two windows). Set it to a small number for normal
|
|
7302 editing.
|
|
7303 Minimum value is 1.
|
|
7304 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
|
|
7305 height of the current window.
|
|
7306 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
|
|
7307 the minimal height for other windows.
|
|
7308
|
|
7309 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
|
|
7310 'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
|
|
7311 local to window
|
|
7312 {not in Vi}
|
|
7313 {not available when compiled without the +windows
|
|
7314 feature}
|
|
7315 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
|
|
7316 'equalalways' is set. Set by default for the |preview-window| and
|
|
7317 |quickfix-window|.
|
|
7318 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
|
|
7319
|
|
7320 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
|
|
7321 'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
|
|
7322 global
|
|
7323 {not in Vi}
|
|
7324 {not available when compiled without the +windows
|
|
7325 feature}
|
|
7326 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
|
|
7327 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
|
|
7328 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
|
|
7329 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
|
|
7330 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
|
|
7331 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
|
|
7332 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
|
|
7333 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
|
|
7334 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
|
|
7335
|
|
7336 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
|
|
7337 'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
|
|
7338 global
|
|
7339 {not in Vi}
|
|
7340 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
|
|
7341 feature}
|
|
7342 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
|
|
7343 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
|
|
7344 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
|
|
7345 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
|
|
7346 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
|
|
7347 to go.)
|
|
7348 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
|
|
7349 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
|
|
7350 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
|
|
7351 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
|
|
7352
|
|
7353 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
|
|
7354 'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
|
|
7355 global
|
|
7356 {not in Vi}
|
|
7357 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
|
|
7358 feature}
|
|
7359 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
|
|
7360 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
|
|
7361 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
|
|
7362 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
|
|
7363 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
|
|
7364 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
|
|
7365 width of the current window.
|
|
7366 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
|
|
7367 the minimal width for other windows.
|
|
7368
|
|
7369 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
|
|
7370 'wrap' boolean (default on)
|
|
7371 local to window
|
|
7372 {not in Vi}
|
|
7373 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
|
|
7374 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
|
|
7375 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
|
10
|
7376 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
|
|
7377 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
|
7
|
7378 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
|
|
7379 horizontally.
|
|
7380 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
|
|
7381 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
|
|
7382 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
|
|
7383 :set sidescroll=5
|
|
7384 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
|
|
7385 < See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
|
|
7386
|
|
7387 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
|
|
7388 'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
|
|
7389 local to buffer
|
|
7390 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
|
|
7391 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
|
|
7392 and inserting continues on the next line.
|
|
7393 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
|
|
7394 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
|
|
7395 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
|
|
7396 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. {Vi: works differently
|
|
7397 and less usefully}
|
|
7398
|
|
7399 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
|
|
7400 'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
|
|
7401 global
|
500
|
7402 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
|
|
7403 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
|
7
|
7404
|
|
7405 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
|
|
7406 'write' boolean (default on)
|
|
7407 global
|
|
7408 {not in Vi}
|
|
7409 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
|
|
7410 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
|
10
|
7411 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
|
7
|
7412 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
|
|
7413 writing a temporary file.
|
|
7414
|
|
7415 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
|
|
7416 'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
|
|
7417 global
|
|
7418 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
|
|
7419
|
|
7420 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
|
|
7421 'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
|
|
7422 otherwise)
|
|
7423 global
|
|
7424 {not in Vi}
|
|
7425 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
|
|
7426 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
|
|
7427 also on. Reset this option if your file system is almost full. See
|
|
7428 |backup-table| for another explanation.
|
|
7429 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
|
|
7430 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
|
|
7431 set.
|
|
7432
|
|
7433 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
|
|
7434 'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
|
|
7435 global
|
|
7436 {not in Vi}
|
|
7437 The number of microseconds to wait for each character sent to the
|
|
7438 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
|
|
7439 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes.
|
|
7440
|
|
7441 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl:
|